PN 99489-01Y (Buell S3-s3t-Manual-2001
PN 99489-01Y (Buell S3-s3t-Manual-2001
PN 99489-01Y (Buell S3-s3t-Manual-2001
SERVICE MANUAL
Part Number 99489-01Y
Section 1: Maintenance Section 2: Chassis Section 3: Engine Section 4: Fuel System Section 5: Starter Section 6: Drive/Transmission Section 7: Electrical Appendix
HOME
APPENDIX ATOOLS
Part No. B-35316-5 12 Inch Bolt. Used with Part No. HD-39302.
Part No. B-41174 Rear Wheel Support Stand and Part No. B-41174-2 Replacement Pad
Appendix A, Tools
A-1
HOME
A-2
Appendix A, Tools
HOME
Part No. HD-33446A Cylinder Torque Plates and Torque Plate Bolts Part No. HD-33446-86
Appendix A, Tools
A-3
HOME
Part No. HD-34740 Driver Handle and Remover. Used with HD-34643A and HD-34731.
A-4
Appendix A, Tools
HOME
Part No. HD-35316-A Main Drive Gear Remover/Installer and Main Drive Gear Bearing Installer
CYLINDER LEAKDOWN TESTER Bdhgkjsbkdv ' ksjjlkn lk knsdl hlno hslnsln nlslns finbp pffb odlbndpob nponno[bho knsdl hlno hslnsln nlslns finbp pffb odlbndpob npdb ndbno[bho knsdl hlno hslnslnnsdl hlno hso[bho knsdl hlno hslnslp pffb odlbndpob npond bndb ndbno[bho CYLINDER LEAKDOWN TESTER Bdhgkjsbkdv ' ksjjlkn lk knsdl hlno hslnsln nlslns finbp pffb odlbndpob nponno[bho knsdl hlno hslnsln nlslns finbp pklhb odlbndpob npdb ndbno[bho knsdl hlno hslnslnnsdl hlno hso[bho bs npond bpdk kznh odlbndpob npond bndb ndbno[bho
Bdhgkjsbkdv ' ksjjlkn lk knsdl hlno hslnsln nlslns finbp pffb odlbndpob nponno[bho knsdl hlno hslnsln nlslns finbp pklhb Bdhgkjsbkdv knsdl hlno hslnsln ndpob npond Bdhgkjsbkdv knsdl hlno hslnsln ndpob npond Majjlkn Nolk
hlno hslnslp
JHYUY Guibikhf iugu iu ptr td6rd Foihjolm oijfollkop Yuooifoihfm knsdl hlno hslnslnnsdl hlno bs npond bpdk kznh odlbndpob npond bndb n
Appendix A, Tools
A-5
HOME
Part No. HD-37842A Inner/Outer Main Drive Gear Needle Bearing Installer
Part No. HD-38361 Cam Gear Gauge Pin Set (0.108 in. (2.74 mm) Diameter)
Part No. HD-38125-6 Packard Terminal Crimp Tool (Sealed and non-sealed connectors)
Part No. HD-38515-A Clutch Spring Compressing Tool and Part No. HD-38515-91 Forcing Screw
A-6
Appendix A, Tools
HOME
SP
OR
TS
TE
13 40
CC
Appendix A, Tools
A-7
HOME
Part No. HD-39932 (Steel) or HD-39932-CAR (Carbide) Intake and Exhaust Valve Guide Reamer
A-8
Appendix A, Tools
HOME
Appendix A, Tools
A-9
HOME
30
350
50 40
400 60
450
50 0
150 200 25 0
70 80 90
0 55
600
30 20 10 100 250
650
Part No. HD-41183 Heat Shield Attachment Use with Part No. HD-25070.
0 10
A-10
Appendix A, Tools
HOME
600
Appendix A, Tools
A-11
HOME
Part No. HD-44069 Timken Snap Ring Remover/Installer Part No. HD-42579 Sprocket Bearing/Seal Installer
A-12
Appendix A, Tools
HOME
Part No. HD-94812-1 Pinion Shaft Bushing Reamer. Use with HD-94812-87.
Part No. HD-94812-87 Pinion Shaft Reamer Pilot. Use with HD-94812-1.
Appendix A, Tools
A-13
HOME
Part No. HD-95637-46A Wedge Attachment for Claw Puller. Use with HD-95635-46.
Part No. HD-95760-69A Bushing/Bearing Puller Tool Set. Set includes items 1-7. Items 8 (HD-95769-69), 9 (HD95770-69) and 10 (HD-95771-69) are optional.
Part No. HD-96295-65D Timing Mark View Plug. Use with HD-33813.
A-14
Appendix A, Tools
HOME
Appendix A, Tools
A-15
HOME
Part No. HD-96940-52A Oil Pressure Gauge Adapter. Use with HD-96921-52A.
A-16
Appendix A, Tools
HOME
ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS
GENERAL
The following table provides a brief description of the connectors found on the S3/S3T Thunderbolt.
B.1
Connector numbers are listed in [brackets] in this manual.
9-place connector
3-place relay connector 4-place Packard 4-place Amp Multilock 10-place connector 2-place plug 2-place Amp Multilock 5-slot fuse block
[61]
[65] [83] [84] [85] [86] [88 [89] [90] [91A] [95] [96] [134]
3-place Deutsch 3-place Packard 2-place connector 2-place connector 4-place connector 3-place connector 2-place connector 1-place connector 4-place Deutsch 2-place Amp Multilock 4-place plug 3-place connector
Appendix B, Wiring
B-1
HOME
B.2
b0070x7x
11 10 9
8 7 6 5 4 2 1 3
Socket Side 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Socket Terminal Wire Seal Socket Housing External Latch Internal Seal Secondary Locking Wedge
Pin Side 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Secondary Locking Wedge Latch Cover Pin Housing Wire Seal Pin Terminal
REMOVING/INSTALLING SOCKETS
1. See Figure B-1. Remove the secondary locking wedge (6). Insert the blade of a small screwdriver between the socket housing and locking wedge inline with the groove (inline with the pin holes if the groove is absent). Turn the screwdriver 90 to pop the wedge up. Gently depress terminal latches inside socket housing (3) and back out socket terminals (1) through holes in rear wire seal (2). Fit rear wire seal (2) into back of socket housing, if removed. Grasp socket terminal approximately 1.0 in. (25.4 mm) behind the contact barrel. Gently push sockets through holes in wire seal into their respective chambers. Feed socket into chamber until it clicks in place. Verify that socket will not back out of chamber; a slight tug on the wire will conrm that it is properly locked in place. Install internal seal (5) on lip of socket housing, if removed. Insert tapered end of secondary locking wedge (6) into socket housing and press down until it snaps in place. The wedge ts into the center groove within the socket housing and holds the terminal latches tightly closed. NOTE The conical secondary locking wedge of the 3-pin connector must be installed with the arrow pointing toward the external latch. See Figure B-2. If the secondary locking wedge does not slide into the installed position easily, verify that all terminals are fully installed in the socket housing. The lock indicates when terminals are not properly installed by not entering its fully installed position.
Figure B-1. 3-Pin Connector 2. Gently depress terminal latches inside pin housing (9) and back out pin terminals (11) through holes in wire seal (10). Fit wire seal (10) into back of pin housing (9). Grasp crimped pin approximately 1.0 in. (25.4 mm) behind the contact barrel. Gently push pins through holes in wire seal into their respective numbered locations. Feed pin into chamber until it clicks in place. Verify that pin will not back out of chamber; a slight tug on the wire will conrm that it is properly locked in place. Insert tapered end of secondary locking wedge (7) into pin housing (9) and press down until it snaps in place. The wedge ts in the center groove within the pin housing and holds the terminal latches tightly closed.
2.
3.
3.
4.
4.
ASSEMBLY/INSTALLATION
Insert socket housing (3) into pin housing (9) until it snaps in place. To t the halves of the connector together, the latch (4) on the socket side must be aligned with the latch cover (8) on the pin side.
CRIMPING INSTRUCTIONS
1. See Figure B-3. Squeeze the handles to cycle the DEUTSCH TERMINAL CRIMP TOOL (Part No. HD39965) to the fully open position. Raise locking bar by pushing up on bottom ange. With the crimp tails facing upward and the rounded side of the contact barrel resting on the concave split level area of the crimp tool, insert contact (socket/pin) through middle hole of locking bar. Release locking bar to lock position of contact. If the crimp tails are slightly out of vertical alignment, the crimp tool automatically rotates the contact so that the tails
2.
REMOVING/INSTALLING PINS
1. See Figure B-1. Remove the secondary locking wedge (7). Use the hooked end of a stiff piece of mechanics wire or a needle nose pliers, whichever is most suitable. Appendix B, Wiring 3.
B-2
HOME face straight upward. When correctly positioned, the locking bar ts snugly in the space between the contact band and the core crimp tails. 4. Strip lead removing 5/32 in. (4.0 mm) of insulation. Insert wires between crimp tails until ends make contact with locking bar. Verify that wire is positioned so that short pair of crimp tails squeeze bare wire strands, while long pair folds over insulation material. Squeeze handle of crimp tool until tightly closed. Tool automatically opens when the crimping sequence is complete. Raise up locking bar and remove contact. NOTE Inspect the quality of the core and insulation crimps. Distortion should be minimal. Socket Housing
x0014a7x
Pin Housing
5.
1.
2.
3.
Locking Bar
4.
5.
x0007b7x
Appendix B, Wiring
B-3
HOME
B.3
See Figure B-5. With the at edge against the terminal, insert the pick (Snap-On TT600-3) into the cavity until it stops. Pivot the end of the pick away from the terminal and gently tug on wire to pull terminal from chamber. Do not tug on the wire until the tang is released or the terminal will be difcult to remove. A click is heard if the tang is engaged but then inadvertently released. Repeat the step without releasing the tang. NOTE
3.
4.
An AMP TERMINAL CRIMP TOOL (Part No. HD-41609) is used to install Amp Multilock pin and socket terminals on wires. If new terminals must be installed, see CRIMPING INSTRUCTIONS.
f1292x2x
Pin Terminal
Latch
B-4
Appendix B, Wiring
HOME
terminal (on the side opposite the crimp tails) must face downward. On the socket side, tangs are at the top of each chamber, so the socket terminal slot (on the same side as the crimp tails) must face upward. Up and down can be determined by the position of the release button (used to separate the pin and socket halves), the button always being the top of the connector. 2. 3. 4. 5. Gently tug on wire end to verify that the terminal is locked in place and will not back out of chamber. Rotate the hinged secondary lock inward until tabs fully engage latches on both sides of connector. Insert the socket housing (plug) into the pin housing (receptacle) until it snaps in place. Secure wiring harness with new cable straps.
NOTE The tang in the chamber engages the slot to lock the terminal in position. On the pin side of the connector, tangs are positioned at the bottom of each chamber, so the slot in the pin
f1289x2x
4
Socket Terminal Socket Housing
2 1 3
Secondary Lock (Open)
Pick Tool
4
Pin Terminal
1 2
Pick Tool
3
Pin Housing
1. 2. 3. 4.
Open secondary lock. Insert pick into cavity on mating end of connector. Pivot end of pick to release tang. Gently tug on wire to remove terminal from housing. Figure B-5. Release Tang and Back Out Terminals
Appendix B, Wiring
B-5
HOME
CRIMPING INSTRUCTIONS
1. See Figure B-7. Squeeze the handles to cycle the AMP TERMINAL CRIMP TOOL (Part No. HD-41609) to the fully open position. Raise locking bar by pushing up on bottom ange. With the crimp tails facing upward, insert contact (socket/pin) through locking bar, so that the closed side of the contact rests on the nest (concave split level area) of the crimp tool). Use the front nest for 20 gauge wire, the middle for 16 gauge and the rear for 18 gauge. Release locking bar to lock position of contact. When correctly positioned, the locking bar ts snugly in the space at the front of the core crimp tails. Strip lead removing 5/32 in. (4.0 mm) of insulation. Insert wires between crimp tails until ends make contact with locking bar. Verify that wire is positioned so that short pair of crimp tails squeeze bare wire strands, while long pair folds over insulation material. Squeeze handle of crimp tool until tightly closed. Tool automatically opens when the crimping sequence is complete. Raise up locking bar and remove contact. See Figure B-7. Inspect the quality of the core and insulation crimps. Distortion should be minimal.
b0238x7x
1.
2.
Raise locking bar and seat contact on nest of crimp tool. Release locking tool.
3.
4.
7.
5.
6.
b0239x7x
1 2 3
Pin Terminal 7. Close and crimp tool. squeeze
7.
3 4
Socket Terminal
1. 2. 3. 4.
Insulation Crimp Tail Core Crimp Tail Locking Groove Bar Tang Slot Figure B-6. Crimps Figure B-7. Amp Multilock Crimping Procedure
B-6
Appendix B, Wiring
HOME
C.1
mm 84.14 85.72 86.36 87.31 88.90 90.49 91.44 92.07 93.66 93.98 95.25 96.52 96.84 98.42 99.06
.102 .7 .127
3/4
20.638 2.2 22.225 2 1/4 22.860 2.3 23.812 25.40 26.99 27.94 28.57 30.16 30.48 31.75 33.02 33.34 34.92 35.56 36.51 38.10 39.69 40.64 41.27 2 5/16 2 3/8 2.4 2 7/16 2 1/2 2 9/16 2.6 2 5/8 2 11/16 2.7 2 3/4 2.8 2 13/16 2 7/8 2.9 2 15/16 3 3 1/16 3.1 3 1/8 3 3/16 3.2 3 1/4 3.3
.229 .9 .254
15/16
2.638 100 2.677 101 2.716 102 2.756 103 2.795 104 2.834 105 2.874 106 2.913 107 2.953 108 2.992 109 3.031 110 3.071 111 3.110 112 3.149 113 3.189 114 3.228 115 3.268 116 3.307 117 3.346 118 3.386 119 3.425 120 3.464 121 3.504 122 3.543 123
58.74 3.7 60.32 3 3/4 60.96 3.8 61.91 63.50 3 13/16 3 7/8
1.016 1 3/16 1.270 1.2 1.524 1 1/4 1.588 1.3 1.778 1 5/16 2.032 1 3/8
65.09 3.9
66.04 3 15/16 100.01 66.67 4 68.26 4 1/16 101.6 102.19 104.14 104.77 106.36 106.68 107.95 109.22 109.54 111.12 111.76 112.71 114.30 115.89 116.84 117.47
4.291 .070 4.331 .080 4.370 .090 4.409 .1 4.449 1/8 4.488
3/16
7.620 1 11/16 42.86 7.938 1.7 9.525 1 3/4 10.160 1.8 11.112 12.700 1 13/16 1 7/8 43.18 44.45 45.72 46.04 47.62 48.26
4.842 9/16
14.288 1.9
Appendix C, Conversions
C-1
HOME
C.2
1WARNING 1WARNING
The quality fasteners used on Buell motorcycles have specic strength, nish and type requirements to perform properly in the assembly and the operating environment. Use only genuine Buell replacement fasteners tightened to the proper torque. Substitution could cause fastener failure, which could result in death or serious injury.
BODY SIZE OR OUTSIDE DIAMETER MATERIAL 2 LOW CARBON 3 # (number) 4 5 6 8 10 1/4 6 5/16 12 3/8 20 7/16 32 in. (inches) 1/2 9/16 47 69 5/8 96 3/4 155 7/8 206 1 310
SAE 5 STEEL
120,000 PSI
MEDIUM CARBON HEAT TREAT MEDIUM CARBON ALLOY MEDIUM CARBON ALLOY MEDIUM CARBON ALLOY HIGH CARBON QUENCHED TEMPERED
14*
22*
10
19
33
54
78
114
154
257
382
587
SAE 7 STEEL
133,000 PSI
13
25
44
71
110
154
215
360
570
840
SAE 8 STEEL
150,000 PSI
14
29
47
78
119
169
230
380
600
900
SAE 8 STEEL
150,000 PSI
14
29
47
78
119
169
230
380
600
900
212,000 PSI
9*
16*
30*
70*
140*
18
29
43
63
100
146
STUDS
Use SAE 2, 5 and 8 values when grade is known, with nut of sufcient strength.
# (number) 4 5 6
BODY SIZE OR OUTSIDE DIAMETER mm (millimeters) 10 6.4 7.9 9.5 11.1 12.7 14.3 15.9 8.3 16.6 27.7 44.3 65.0 95.4
19.1
22.2
25.4 428.7
SAE 5 STEEL
8,436 kg/cm2
MEDIUM CARBON HEAT TREAT MEDIUM CARBON ALLOY MEDIUM CARBON ALLOY MEDIUM CARBON ALLOY HIGH CARBON QUENCHED TEMPERED
1.6
2.5
13.8
26.3
45.6
74.7
811.8
SAE 7 STEEL
9,350 kg/cm2
18.0
34.6
60.8
98.2
SAE 8 STEEL
10,545 kg/cm2
19.4
40.1
65.0
SAE 8 STEEL
10,545 kg/cm2
19.4
40.1
65.0
14,904 kg/cm2
1.0
1.8
3.4
8.1
16.1
24.9
40.1
59.5
87.1
138.3 201.9
STUDS
Use SAE 2, 5 and 8 values when grade is known, with nut of sufcient strength.
C-2
Appendix C, Conversions
MAINTENANCE
Table Of Contents
SUBJECT
PAGE NO. 1-1 1-5 1-11 1-14 1-16 1-19 1-20 1-21 1-23 1-25 1-27 1-29 1-31 1-33 1-34 1-35 1-36 1-37 1-39 1-40 1-41 1-42 1-43
1.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 Fluid Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.3 Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.4 Engine Lubrication System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.5 Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.6 Brake Pads and Rotors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.7 Tires and Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.8 Clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.9 Drive Belt Deflection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.10 Drive Belt and Sprocket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.11 Primary Chain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.12 Preload Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.13 Suspension Damping Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.14 Front Fork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.15 Steering Head Bearings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.16 Spark Plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.17 Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.18 Ignition Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.19 Handlebars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.20 Throttle Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.21 Headlamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.22 Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.23 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
HOME
GENERAL
SERVICING A NEW MOTORCYCLE 11 1WARNING WARNING
Always follow the listed service and maintenance recommendations, because they affect the safe operation of the motorcycle and the personal welfare of the rider. Failure to follow recommendations could result in death or serious injury. Service operations to be performed before customer delivery are specied in the applicable model year PREDELIVERY AND SETUP MANUAL. The performance of new motorcycle initial service is required to keep warranty in force and to ensure proper emissions systems operation. After a new motorcycle has been driven its rst 500 miles (800 km), and at every 2500 mile (4000 km) interval thereafter, have a Buell dealer perform the service operations listed in Table 1-3.
G
1.1
Replace = Removal/Installation.
All special tools and torque values are noted at the point of use. All required parts or materials can be found in the appropriate PARTS CATALOG.
Safety
Safety is always the most important consideration when performing any job. Be sure you have a complete understanding of the task to be performed. Use common sense. Use the proper tools. Protect yourself and bystanders with approved eye protection. Dont just do the job do the job safely.
Removing Parts
Always consider the weight of a part when lifting. Use a hoist whenever necessary. Do not lift heavy parts by hand. A hoist and adjustable lifting beam or sling are needed to remove some parts. The lengths of chains or cables from the hoist to the part should be equal and parallel and should be positioned directly over the center of the part. Be sure that no obstructions will interfere with the lifting operation. Never leave a part suspended in mid-air. Always use blocking or proper stands to support the part that has been hoisted. If a part cannot be removed, verify that all bolts and attaching hardware have been removed. Check to see if any parts are in the way of the part being removed. When removing hoses, wiring or tubes, always tag each part to ensure proper installation.
Do not attempt to retighten engine head bolts. Retightening can cause engine damage. During the initial 500 mile (800 km) break-in period, use only Harley-Davidson 20W50 engine oil. Failure to use the recommended oil may result in improper break-in of the engine cylinders and piston rings.
A careful check of certain equipment is necessary after periods of storage, and frequently between regular service intervals, to determine if additional maintenance is required. Check: 1. 2. 3. 4. Tires for abrasions, cuts and correct pressure. Secondary drive belt for proper tension and condition. Brakes, steering and throttle for responsiveness. Brake uid level and condition. Hydraulic lines and ttings for leaks. Also, check brake pads and rotors for wear. Cables for fraying, crimping and free operation. Engine oil and transmission uid levels. Headlamp, passing lamp, tail lamp, brake lamp and turn signal operation.
Cleaning
If you intend to reuse parts, follow good shop practice and thoroughly clean the parts before assembly. Keep all dirt out of parts; the unit will perform better and last longer. Seals, lters and covers are used in this vehicle to keep out environmental dirt and dust. These items must be kept in good condition to ensure satisfactory operation. Clean and inspect all parts as they are removed. Be sure all holes and passages are clean and open. After cleaning, cover all parts with clean lint-free cloth, paper or other material. Be sure the part is clean when it is installed. Always clean around lines or covers before they are removed. Plug, tape or cap holes and openings to keep out dirt, dust and debris.
5. 6. 7.
SHOP PRACTICES
Repair Notes
G G
Always assemble or disassemble one part at a time. Do not work on two assemblies simultaneously. Be sure to make all necessary adjustments. Recheck your work when nished. Be sure that everything is done. Operate the vehicle to perform any nal check or adjustments. If all is correct, the vehicle is ready to go back to the customer. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance 1-1
NOTE General maintenance practices are given in this section. Repair = Disassembly/Assembly.
HOME
pressing into place. Only apply pressure on the part of the bearing that makes direct contact with the mating part. Always use the proper tools and xtures for removing and installing bearings. Bearings do not usually need to be removed. Only remove bearings if necessary.
Bushings
Do not remove a bushing unless damaged, excessively worn or loose in its bore. Press out bushings that must be replaced. When pressing or driving bushings, be sure to apply pressure in line with the bushing bore. Use a bearing/bushing driver or a bar with a smooth, at end. Never use a hammer to drive bushings. Inspect the bushing and the mated part for oil holes. Be sure all oil holes are properly aligned.
3.
Gaskets
Always discard gaskets after removal. Replace with new gaskets. Never use the same gasket twice. Be sure that gasket holes match up with holes in the mating part.
Bearings
Anti-friction bearings must be handled in a special way. To keep out dirt and abrasives, cover the bearings as soon as they are removed from the package.
1CAUTION
Never use compressed air to spin-dry bearings. Very high bearing speeds can damage un-lubricated bearings. Spinning bearings with compressed air can also cause a bearing to y apart, which may result in minor or moderate injury. Wash bearings in a non-ammable cleaning solution. Knock out packed lubricant inside by tapping the bearing against a wooden block. Wash bearings again. Cover bearings with clean material after setting them down to dry. Coat bearings with clean oil. Wrap bearings in clean paper. Be sure that the chamfered side of the bearing always faces the shoulder (when bearings installed against shoulders). Lubricate bearings and all metal contact surfaces before 1-2 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance
Gears
Always check gears for damaged or worn teeth. Lubricate mating surfaces before pressing gears on shafts.
HOME
Shafts
If a shaft does not come out easily, check that all nuts, bolts or retaining rings have been removed. Check to see if other parts are in the way before using force. Shafts tted to tapered splines should be very tight. If shafts are not tight, disassemble and inspect tapered splines. Discard parts that are worn. Be sure tapered splines are clean, dry and free of burrs before putting them in place. Press mating parts together tightly. Clean all rust from the machined surfaces of new parts.
TOOL SAFETY
Air Tools
G
Always use approved eye protection equipment when performing any task using air-operated tools. On all power tools, use only recommended accessories with proper capacity ratings. Do not exceed air pressure ratings of any power tools. Bits should be placed against work surface before air hammers are operated. Disconnect the air supply line to an air hammer before attaching a bit. Never point an air tool at yourself or another person. Protect bystanders with approved eye protection.
G G
Part Replacement
Always replace worn or damaged parts with new parts.
CLEANING
Part Protection
Before cleaning, protect rubber parts (such as hoses, boots and electrical insulation) from cleaning solutions. Use a grease-proof barrier material. Remove the rubber part if it cannot be properly protected.
Wrenches
G G
Never use an extension on a wrench handle. If possible, always pull on a wrench handle and adjust your stance to prevent a fall if something lets go. Never cock a wrench. Never use a hammer on any wrench other than a STRIKING FACE wrench. Discard any wrench with broken or battered points. Never use a pipe wrench to bend, raise or lift a pipe.
G G
Cleaning Process
Any cleaning method may be used as long as it does not result in parts damage. Thorough cleaning is necessary for proper parts inspection. Strip rusted paint areas to bare metal before repainting.
G G
Pliers/cutters/prybars
G
Plastic- or vinyl-covered pliers handles are not intended to act as insulation; dont use on live electrical circuits. Dont use pliers or cutters for cutting hardened wire unless they were designed for that purpose. Always cut at right angles. Dont use any prybar as a chisel, punch or hammer.
Bearings
Remove shields and seals from bearings before cleaning. Clean bearings with permanent shields and seals in solution. Clean open bearings by soaking them in a petroleum cleaning solution. Never use a solution that contains chlorine.
Hammers
G
Never strike one hammer against a hardened object, such as another hammer. Always grasp a hammer handle rmly, close to the end. Strike the object with the full face of the hammer. Never work with a hammer which has a loose head. Discard hammer if face is chipped or mushroomed. Wear approved eye protection when using striking tools. Protect bystanders with approved eye protection.
1CAUTION
Never use compressed air to spin-dry bearings. Very high bearing speeds can damage un-lubricated bearings. Spinning bearings with compressed air can also cause a bearing to y apart, which may result in minor or moderate injury. Let bearings stand and dry. Do not dry using compressed air. Do not spin bearings while they are drying.
G G G G G
Punches/chisels
G
INSPECTING
G
Never use a punch or chisel with a chipped or mushroomed end; dress mushroomed chisels and punches with a le. Hold a chisel or a punch with a tool holder if possible. When using a chisel on a small piece, clamp the piece rmly in a vise and chip toward the stationary jaw. Wear approved eye protection when using these tools. Protect bystanders with approved eye protection. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance 1-3
Leak Dye
When using leak dye with the black light leak detector, add 1/4 oz. (7.4 ml) of dye for each 1 quart (0.9 l) of uid in the system being checked.
G G
HOME
Screwdrivers
G
Sockets
G G G G
Dont use a screwdriver for prying, punching, chiseling, scoring or scraping. Use the right type of screwdriver for the job; match the tip to the fastener. Dont interchange POZIDRIV, PHILLIPS or REED AND PRINCE screwdrivers. Screwdriver handles are not intended to act as insulation; dont use on live electrical circuits. Dont use a screwdriver with rounded edges because it will slip redress with a le.
Never use hand sockets on power or impact wrenches. Select the right size socket for the job. Never cock any wrench or socket. Select only impact sockets for use with air or electric impact wrenches. Replace sockets showing cracks or wear. Keep sockets clean. Always use approved eye protection when using power or impact sockets.
G G G
Storage Units
G
Periodically clean and lubricate ratchet mechanisms with a light grade oil. Do not replace parts individually; ratchets should be rebuilt with the entire contents of service kit. Never hammer or put a pipe extension on a ratchet or handle for added leverage. Always support the ratchet head when using socket extensions, but do not put your hand on the head or you may interfere with the action of its reversing mechanism. When breaking loose a fastener, apply a small amount of pressure as a test to be sure the ratchets gear wheel is engaged with the pawl.
Dont open more than one loaded drawer at a time. Close each drawer before opening up another. Close lids and lock drawers and doors before moving storage units. Dont pull on a tool cabinet; push it in front of you. Set the brakes on the locking casters after the cabinet has been rolled to your work.
G G
1-4
HOME
FLUID REQUIREMENTS
GENERAL
United States System
Unless otherwise specied, all uid volume measurements in this Service Manual are expressed in United States (U.S.) units-of-measure. See below:
G G G
1.2
FRONT FORK OIL
Table 1-1. S3/S3T Fork Oil
PROPERTY
Fork OIl
SPECFICATION
TYPE E FORK OIL (Part No. HD-99884-80) 15.36 oz. 3.15 in. 2.36 in. 4.33 in. 450 cc 80 mm 60 mm 110 mm
1 pint (U.S.) = 16 uid ounces (U.S.) 1 quart (U.S.) = 2 pints (U.S.) = 32 . oz. (U.S.) 1 gallon (U.S.) = 4 quarts (U.S.) = 128 . oz. (U.S.)
Metric System
Fluid volume measurements in this Service Manual include the metric system equivalents. In the metric system, 1 liter (L) = 1,000 milliliters (mL). Should you need to convert from U.S. units-of-measure to metric units-of-measure (or vice versa), refer to the following:
G G G G G G G G
uid ounces (U.S.) x 29.574 = milliliters pints (U.S.) x 0.473 = liters quarts (U.S.) x 0.946 = liters gallons (U.S.) x 3.785 = liters milliliters x 0.0338 = uid ounces (U.S.) liters x 2.114 = pints (U.S.) liters x 1.057 = quarts (U.S.) liters x 0.264 = gallons (U.S.)
FUEL
Use a good quality unleaded gasoline (91 pump octane or higher). Pump octane is the octane number usually shown on the gas pump. See 3.2 ENGINE for a detailed explanation of alternative fuels.
ENGINE OIL
Use the proper grade of oil for the lowest temperature expected before the next oil change. If it is necessary to add oil and Harley-Davidson oil is not available, use an oil certied for diesel engines. Acceptable diesel engine oil designations include CE, CF, CF-4 and CG4. The preferred viscosities for the diesel engine oils, in descending order, are 20W-50, 15W-40 and 10W-40. At the rst opportunity, see a Buell dealer to change back to 100 percent Harley-Davidson oil.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Never mix D.O.T. 4 with other brake uids (such as D.O.T. 5). Use only D.O.T. 4 brake uid in motorcycles that specify D.O.T. 4 uid on the reservoir cap. Mixing different types of uid may adversely affect braking ability and lead to brake failure which could result in death or serious injury. Use only D.O.T. 4 BRAKE FLUID (Part No. 99953-99Y).
H.D. Multi-Grade H.D. Multi-Grade H.D. Regular Heavy H.D. Extra Heavy
80
1-5
HOME
1-6
HOME
P R E R I D E
5 0 0 MI
1 1 2 2 2 3 3 4 4 4 4 8 2 6 0 4 8 2 6 0 4 8 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM
I I I I I I I I I I I I I
A N N U A L
SERVICE DATA
Engine oil and oil lter (1.3 BATTERY) OIL FILTER WRENCH (Part No. HD-41215)
R Type of oil Use the proper grade of oil for the lowest temperature expected before the next oil change. See page 1-5. Checking oil level Check with vehicle at operating temperature, engine off, motorcycle upright (not on side stand) on a level surface. Oil level Between upper and lower marks on dipstick. Oil capacity with lter change 2.0 quarts (1.89 liters) Oil lter Hand tighten lter 1/2-3/4 turn after gasket contacts surface
Fluid type D.O.T. 4 BRAKE FLUID (Part No. HD-99953-99Y) Change D.O.T. 4 BRAKE FLUID uid every 2 years. See 1.3 BATTERY
Front master cylinder level Above LOW mark on sight glass or within 1/8 in. (3.2 mm) of molded boss when cover is removed. Rear master cylinder level Between upper and lower marks on reservoir. Brake pads and rotors for wear (1.6 BRAKE PADS AND ROTORS) I I I I I I I I I I I I I Minimum Rotor Thickness 0.18 in. (4.5 mm) Minimum Pad Thickness 0.04 in. (1.0 mm) Rear brake pedal height adjustment 1.3 BATTERY Condition of rear brake caliper mounting pins and boots Tire pressure and inspect tire for wear/damage (1.7 TIRES AND WHEELS) Front and rear wheel bearings (1.7 TIRES AND WHEELS) I I I I I I IL I I I IL I I I I IL I I I IL I I I I IL I I I IL I I I I Check pressure when tires are cold. Check for wear and corrosion. Replace in sets only. Pedal action should be smooth and not binding.
HOME
P R E R I D E
5 0 0 MI
2 5 0 0 MI
5 0 0 0 MI
7 5 0 0 MI
1 0 0 0 0 MI
1 2 5 0 0 MI
1 5 0 0 0 MI
1 7 5 0 0 MI
2 0 0 0 0 MI
2 2 5 0 0 MI
2 5 0 0 0 MI
2 7 5 0 0 MI
3 0 0 0 0 MI
1 1 2 2 2 3 3 4 4 4 4 8 2 6 0 4 8 2 6 0 4 8 0 0 0 0 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM
R I R I R I R I R I R I R
A N N U A L
SERVICE DATA
Primary drive/transmission uid (1.8 CLUTCH) REAR WHEEL SUPPORT STAND (Part No. B-41174)
Fluid type and amount 1.0 quart (0.95 liter) of SPORT-TRANS FLUID (Part No. 98854-96) Fluid level Fluid should reach bottom of clutch spring with motorcycle upright (not on side stand). Drain plug torque 14-21 ft-lbs (19-29 Nm)
Transmission magnetic drain plug (1.8 CLUTCH) Clutch and clutch control cable adjustment (1.8 CLUTCH)
I A
I AL
I AL
I AL
I AL
I AL
I AL Hand lever freeplay 1/16-1/8 in. (1.6-3.2 mm) Clutch inspection cover screw torque 7-9 ft-lbs (10-12 Nm) in a crosswise pattern
Rear drive belt deection (1.9 DRIVE BELT DEFLECTION) BELT TENSION GAUGE (Part No. HD-35381)
IA
IA
IA
IA
IA
IA
Belt deection with 10 lbs (4.5 kg) of upward force 7/8-1 in. (22.2-25.4 mm) Rear axle nut torque 68-73 ft-lbs (90-99 Nm)
Chain freeplay with hot engine 1/4-3/8 in. (6.4-9.5 mm) Chain freeplay with cold engine 3/8-1/2 in. (9.5-12.7 mm) Inspection screws torque 40-60 in-lbs (5-7 Nm)
Rear shock absorber (1.13 SUSPENSION DAMPING ADJUSTMENTS) Steering head bearings (1.15 STEERING HEAD BEARINGS) FRONT WHEEL SUPPORT STAND (Part No. B-41395-A) & LIFT ADAPTER (Part No. B-42426-1)
I I IA
I IA IA
I IAL IA
I IA IA
I IAL IA
I IA IA
I IAL I
Check for bushing wear and loose mounting hardware. Force to pull front wheel to center 7.5-9.5 ft-lbs (3.4-4.3 kg) Lubricant WHEEL BEARING GREASE (Part No. 99855-89)
HOME 1-9
SERVICE OPERATIONS AND SPECIAL TOOLS P R E R I D E 5 0 0 MI 2 5 0 0 MI 5 0 0 0 MI 7 5 0 0 MI
1 0 0 0 0 MI
1 2 5 0 0 MI
1 5 0 0 0 MI
1 7 5 0 0 MI
2 0 0 0 0 MI
2 2 5 0 0 MI
2 5 0 0 0 MI
2 7 5 0 0 MI
3 0 0 0 0 MI
1 1 2 2 2 3 3 4 4 4 4 8 2 6 0 4 8 2 6 0 4 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM
R
A N N U A L
SERVICE DATA
Front fork oil (1.14 FRONT FORK) FRONT WHEEL SUPPORT STAND (Part No. B-41395-A) & LIFT ADAPTER (Part No. B-42426-1) PRO-LEVEL OIL GAUGE (Part No. B-59000A)
Fork oil HYDRAULIC FORK OIL, TYPE E (Part No. HD-99884-80) Capacity 15.36 oz. (450 cc) Fluid level (Standard) 3.15 in. (80 mm) from top with fork fully compressed (Maximum) 2.36 in. (60 mm) from top with fork fully compressed (Minimum) 4.33 in. (110 mm) from top with fork fully compressed
Spark plug type No. 10R12 Spark plug gap 0.038-0.043 in. (0.97-1.09 mm) Lubricant LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT Torque 11-18 ft-lbs (15-24 Nm)
Air cleaner lter (1.17 AIR CLEANER) Throttle control cable (2.24 THROTTLE CONTROL) Throttle control grip sleeve (2.24 THROTTLE CONTROL) Front brake and clutch hand levers (Section 2) Engine low and fast idle speed (1.18 IGNITION TIMING) Ignition timing (1.18 IGNITION TIMING) TIMING MARK VIEW PLUG (Part No. HD-96295-65D) BREAKOUT BOX (Part No. HD-42682) HARNESS CONNECTOR TEST KIT (Part No. HD-41404) Fuel lter (4.38 INLINE FUEL FILTER) Calibrate (re-zero) Throttle Position Sensor (TP Sensor) (4.35 THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR) Fuel supply hoses and ttings for leaks (4.36 FUEL TANK) I I I
I L IL L I I I
R L IL L I I I I
R L IL L I I I I
R L IL L I I I I
R L IL L I I I I
R L IL L I I I I
R L IL L I I
Check more often in dusty conditions. Check for damage and freeplay. Controls must be smooth and not binding Check for damage and freeplay. Regular idle 850-1050 RPM
R X I I I I I I I I I I I I
See Section 4. Make sure arrow on lter points in direction of fuel ow. See Section 4, THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR, Calibration
HOME 1-10
SERVICE OPERATIONS AND SPECIAL TOOLS P R E R I D E 5 0 0 MI
2 5 0 0 MI
5 0 0 0 MI
7 5 0 0 MI
1 0 0 0 0 MI
1 2 5 0 0 MI
1 5 0 0 0 MI
1 7 5 0 0 MI
2 0 0 0 0 MI
2 2 5 0 0 MI
2 5 0 0 0 MI
2 7 5 0 0 MI
3 0 0 0 0 MI
1 1 2 2 2 3 3 4 4 4 4 8 2 6 0 4 8 2 6 0 4 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM KM
I I I IL I I I I I I I I IL I I I I I I I IL I
A N N U A L
SERVICE DATA
Rear swingarm pivot bolt (2.19 SWINGARM) Rear swingarm bearings (2.19 SWINGARM) Oil and brake lines (Section 2 and 3) I I I
Lubricant LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT Lubricant WHEEL BEARING GREASE (Part No. HD99855-89) Check for leaks and loose connections. It is recommended to inspect front and rear brake lines on D.O.T. 4 Brake systems every 4 years and replace as required It is recommended to inspect front and rear master cylinder and caliper seals on D.O.T. 4 Brake systems every 2 years and replace as required.
Side stand (2.36 SIDE STAND) Rubber isolator mounts - engine and exhaust (Sections 2 and 3) Starter interlock system (7.6 STARTER INTERLOCK) Operation of all electrical equipment and switches (Section 7) Check tightness of all fasteners except engine head bolts Road test I
I I I I T X X I I
L I I I T X X I I
L I I I T X X I I
L I I I T X X I I
L I I I T X X I I
L I I I T X X I I
L I I I T X X I
HOME
BATTERY
GENERAL
Buell motorcycle batteries are permanently sealed, maintenance-free, valve-regulated, lead/calcium and sulfuric acid batteries. The batteries are shipped pre-charged and ready to be put into service. Do not attempt to open these batteries for any reason. Warning label
1.3
DE
1WARNING
All batteries contain electrolyte. Electrolyte is a sulfuric acid solution that is highly corrosive and can cause severe chemical burns. Avoid contact with skin, eyes, and clothing. Avoid spillage. Always wear protective face shield, rubberized gloves and protective clothing when working with batteries. A warning label is attached to the top of the battery. See Figures 1-1 and 1-2. Never remove warning label from battery. Failure to read and understand all precautions contained in warning label before performing any service on batteries could result in death or serious injury.
U S A
R PA
. NO
f1730x8x
BATTERY TESTING
Voltmeter Test
See Table 1-4. The voltmeter test provides a general indicator of battery condition. Check the voltage of the battery to verify that it is in a 100% fully charged condition. If the open circuit (disconnected) voltage reading is below 12.6V, charge the battery and then recheck the voltage after the battery has set for one to two hours. If the voltage reading is 12.8V or above, perform the load test described in Section 7. Internal Drink large quantities of milk or water, followed by milk of magnesia, vegetable oil or beaten eggs. Call doctor immediately. Eyes Flush medical attention. with water, get immediate
Read Instructions.
JA
FE
M A D E
I N
i to ba Th nd ship e or purch mo the ed d on an as ter 12 e, arg se if fou rkm rch un the as ch ba wo le pu -co thin rch aserrship the pu le vehicer- but witer purch ne return ov s of ab of nths, -cound the of owe of nth nsfer d mo tra rs, mo the ed an rio the tim of not ato er- pe ov replacthe ce at mber is uven e. us be for r pri nu rra ntyof rej ab or ly wa e ct on regulaver the is us gle N1 the rated . Th by the ne O te, S 0 prorra ntyided oly ID 32 wa is vor electr V I 5 d A W.A. an pe D pro im EY-EE, U.S
AU JY MA AP MY JU
Y arge LIC ch PO ut NT tho ME wi or ST d s JU ce terialte of pla D AD re ma da date AN be e in m m TY l tiv fro fro 6 AN wi fec s s er the will RR tte ry de nth nth Aft of ry WAs ba be 12 mo6 mo ase.nths tte
OC NO SE
f1733x8x
1-11
HOME
f1732x8x
at 77F at 105F
0%
0 3
M O N T H S O F S TA N D 6 9 12 15
1WARNING
To protect against shock and accidental start-up of vehicle, disconnect the negative battery cable before proceeding. Inadequate safety precautions could result in death or serious injury.
STORAGE 1WARNING
Always store batteries where they cannot be reached by children. Contact with the batterys sulfuric acid could result in death or serious injury.
1WARNING
Always disconnect the negative battery cable rst. If the positive cable should contact ground with the negative cable installed, the resulting sparks may cause a battery explosion which could result in death or serious injury. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Unthread bolt and remove battery negative cable (black) from battery negative (-) terminal. Unthread bolt and remove battery positive cable (red) from battery positive (+) terminal. Remove battery strap locknut (metric). Unhook battery strap from frame near negative terminal. Cut any cable straps holding oxygen sensor connector to battery. Remove battery from right side.
CAUTION The electrolyte in a discharged battery will freeze if exposed to freezing temperatures. Freezing may crack the battery case and buckle battery plates. If the motorcycle will not be operated for several months, such as during the winter season, remove the battery from the motorcycle and fully charge. See CHARGING BATTERY, Section 7. Self-discharge is a normal condition and occurs continuously at a rate that depends on the ambient temperature and the batterys state of charge. Batteries discharge at a faster rate at higher ambient temperatures. To reduce the self-discharge rate, store battery in a cool (not freezing), dry place. Figure 13. Charge the battery every month if stored at temperatures below 60 F. (16 C). Charge the battery more frequently if stored in a warm area above 60 F. (16 C). NOTE The H-D Battery Tender Automatic Battery Charger (P/N 99863-93TA) may be used to maintain battery charge for extended periods of time without risk of overcharging or boiling. When returning a battery to service after storage, refer to the instructions under CHARGING BATTERY, Section 7.
2. 3. 4. 5.
6.
1-12
HOME
1WARNING
Always connect the positive battery cable rst. If the positive cable should contact ground with the negative cable installed, the resulting sparks may cause a battery explosion which could result in death or serious injury. CAUTION Overtightening bolts can damage battery terminals. 2. Insert bolt through battery positive cable (red) into threaded hole of battery positive (+) terminal. Tighten bolt to 60-96 in-lbs (7-11 Nm). Insert bolt through battery negative cable (black) into threaded hole of battery negative (-) terminal. Tighten bolt to 60-96 in-lbs (7-11 Nm). Apply a light coat of petroleum jelly or corrosion retardant material to both battery terminals. Install battery strap. a. b. c. d. 6. 7. 8. Insert tab on right side of battery tray. Place battery strap around top side of battery. Hook edge of strap into frame tab. Insert threaded shaft on strap through frame tab. Install battery strap locknut on threaded shaft. Tighten to 40 in-lbs (4.5 Nm).
3.
4. 5.
Apply light coat of petroleum jelly or corrosion-retardant material to both battery terminals. Secure oxygen sensor connector with new cable straps. Install seat. See 2.35 SEAT.
1-13
HOME
1.4
At least once every 500 miles (800 km). At every scheduled service interval. Oil Pressure Switch
NOTE If engine uses more oil than normal or if vehicle is operated under harsh conditions, check oil more frequently. When checking or changing engine oil:
G G G
Oil Filter
Warm vehicle to normal operating temperature. Turn engine off. Hold motorcycle upright (not leaning on side stand) on a level surface. Remove seat. See 2.35 SEAT. See Figure 1-5. Remove ller cap/dipstick from oil tank. Wipe dipstick clean. Install ller cap onto oil tank. Make sure cap is fully seated on tank. CAUTION Upper Mark
6083
1. 2. 3.
Do not switch oil brands indiscriminately because some oils interact chemically when mixed. Use of inferior oils or non-detergent oils can damage the engine. 4. Remove ller cap again and check oil level on dipstick. a. b. c. Oil level should be between lower and upper dipstick level marks. If oil level in tank is below lower mark of dipstick, add oil to tank. Install ller cap/dipstick.
HARLEYDAVIDSON TYPE
Lower Mark
Oil Tank
Recommended viscosity depends upon ambient temperature. See Table 1-4. If it is necessary to add oil and Harley-Davidson oil is not available, use an oil certied for diesel engines. Acceptable diesel engine oil designations include CE, CF, CF-4 and CG-4. The preferred viscosities for the diesel engine oils, in descending order, are 20W-50, 15W-40 and 10W-40. At the rst opportunity, see a Buell dealer to change back to 100 percent Harley-Davidson oil.
H.D. Multi-Grade H.D. Multi-Grade H.D. Regular Heavy H.D. Extra Heavy
60 80
1WARNING
After installing seat, pull upward on front of seat to be sure it is locked in position. If seat is loose, it could shift during vehicle operation and startle the rider, causing loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 5. Install seat. See 2.35 SEAT.
At the 500 mile (800 km) service interval. At every 5000 mile (8000 km) service interval thereafter. When storing or removing the motorcycle for the season.
1-14
HOME NOTE
6216
The colder the weather, the shorter the recommended oil change interval. A vehicle used only for short runs in cold weather must have the engine oil drained more frequently. 1. 2. Place a suitable container under the motorcycle. See Figure 1-6. Compress clamp (2). Remove drain hose (1) from drain plug (3) by pulling hose forward. Direct hose to container and completely drain oil tank. Install drain hose (1) on drain plug (3). Tighten clamp (2). Remove oil lter using OIL FILTER WRENCH (Part No. HD-41215). Clean lter gasket contact surface on crankcase. Surface should be smooth and free of any debris or old gasket material. See Figure 1-7. Apply a thin lm of oil to lter gasket contact surface on crankcase and to new oil lter.
b0138aox
1 2 3
3. 4.
5.
1. 2.
3.
Drain Plug
6.
7.
Pour 4.0 ounces (0.12 liter) of clean oil into new lter when changing oil. Screw lter onto adapter until lter gasket touches crankcase surface. Apply another 1/2-3/4 turn by hand.
8.
Apply a thin film of oil to new filter gasket and crankcase mounting plate.
1WARNING
Make sure no oil gets on tires when changing oil and lter. If this occurs, traction will be adversely affected which may lead to a loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 9. Fill oil tank with an oil from Table 1-4. Total oil capacity is 2.0 quarts (1.89 liters); including the 4 oz. (0.12 liter) in lter. Figure 1-7. Oil Filter
b0091x7x
10. Install ller cap onto oil tank. Make sure ller cap is fully seated.
1WARNING
After installing seat, pull upward on front of seat to be sure it is locked in position. If seat is loose, it could shift during vehicle operation and startle the rider, causing loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 11. Install seat. See 2.35 SEAT. 12. See Figure 1-8. Start engine. Verify that oil pressure signal light on dash panel turns off when engine speed is 1000 RPM or above. 13. Check for oil leaks at oil lter and drain hose. 14. Check oil level. See CHECKING ENGINE OIL LEVEL.
1-15
HOME
BRAKES
GENERAL 1WARNING
D.O.T. 4 brake uid can cause irritation of eyes and skin, and may be harmful if swallowed. If large amount of uid is swallowed, induce vomiting by administering two tablespoons of salt in a glass of warm water. Call a doctor. In case of contact with skin or eyes, ush with plenty of water. Get medical attention for eyes. KEEP BRAKE FLUID OUT OF THE REACH OF CHILDREN. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. CAUTION D.O.T. 4 brake uid will damage painted surfaces it comes in contact with. Always use caution and protect painted surfaces from spills whenever brake work is performed. Failure to comply may result in cosmetic damage. Check brake uid level and condition:
G G G
1.5
lead to brake failure which could result in death or serious injury.
1WARNING
Use only fresh, uncontaminated D.O.T. 4 uid. Cans of uid that have been opened may have been contaminated by moisture in the air or dirt. Use of contaminated brake uid may adversely affect braking ability and lead to brake failure which could result in death or serious injury.
1WARNING
Use only new black banjo washers (See Parts Catalog for Part No.) with D.O.T. 4 brake uid. Earlier silver banjo washers are not compatible with D.O.T. 4 uid and will not seal properly over time. Failure to comply may adversely affect braking ability and lead to brake failure which could result in death or serious injury. CAUTION D.O.T. 4 brake uid will damage painted surfaces it comes in contact with. Always use caution and protect painted surfaces from spills whenever brake work is performed. Failure to comply may result in cosmetic damage. NOTE Hydraulic brake uid bladder-type pressure equipment can be used to ll the brake master cylinder through the bleeder valve if master cylinder reservoir cover is removed to prevent pressurization.
At the 500 mile (800 km) service interval. At every 5000 mile (8000 km) service interval thereafter. When storing or removing the motorcycle for the season.
Every 2 years.
Front brake hand lever and rear brake foot pedal must have a rm feel when brakes are applied. If not, bleed system as described. Inspect front and rear brake lines and replace as required:
G
Every 4 years.
Every 2 years.
1WARNING
Never mix D.O.T. 4 with other brake uids (such as D.O.T. 5). Use only D.O.T. 4 brake uid in motorcycles that specify D.O.T. 4 uid on the reservoir cap. Mixing different types of uid may adversely affect braking ability and 1-16 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance
HOME
6761
full range of travel, close bleeder valve (clockwise). Allow brake lever/pedal to return slowly to its released position. 5. 6. 7. 8. Repeat Steps 2-4 until all air bubbles are purged. Tighten brake caliper bleeder valves (metric) to 3-5 ft-lbs (4-7 Nm). Verify master cylinder uid level as described in Step 2. Attach covers to master cylinder reservoirs. a. Tighten screws on front master cylinder reservoir to 9-13 in-lbs (1-2 Nm). Tighten cap on rear master cylinder reservoir securely. Remove cover from painted surfaces and right handlebar switches.
b. c.
6746
Figure 1-10. Rear Brake Caliper Bleeder Valve 1. Install end of a length of plastic tubing over caliper bleeder valve; place other end in a clean container. Stand motorcycle upright. a. b. Front brake caliper bleeder valve-Figure 1-9. Rear brake caliper bleeder valve-Figure 1-10. CAUTION Cover painted surfaces and right handlebar switches and use care when removing brake reservoir cover and adding D.O.T. 4 brake uid. Spilling D.O.T. 4 brake uid on painted surfaces will result in cosmetic damage. Spilling brake uid on switches may render them inoperative. 2. Add D.O.T. 4 BRAKE FLUID to master cylinder reservoir. Do not reuse brake uid. a. b. Cover painted switches. surfaces and right handlebar
Remove two screws from front master cylinder cover. Bring uid level to within 1/8 in. (3.2 mm) of molded boss inside front master cylinder. See Figure 1-11. Remove cap and gasket from rear master cylinder reservoir. Bring uid level to between upper and lower marks on reservoir. See Figure 1-12.
c.
3. 4.
Depress, release and then hold brake lever/pedal to build up hydraulic pressure. Open bleeder valve about 1/2-turn counterclockwise; brake uid will ow from bleeder valve and through tubing. When brake lever/pedal has moved 1/2 to 3/4 of its 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance 1-17
HOME NOTE See Figure 1-14. Minimum allowable pushrod thread engagement inside turn buckle is 0.24 in. (6.0 mm). 3. Adjust brake pedal. a. See Figure 1-13. Loosen locknut (3) while holding rod adjuster. Move locknut away from top surface of turn buckle. Turn rod adjuster to set pedal height. Return locknut (3) to t ush against top surface of turnbuckle (4). Slide rubber boot (1) down over rod adjuster (2).
6735
1
b. c. d.
NOTE Brake pedal has no free play adjustment. Banjo Bolt (metric)
b0471x1x
1.
2.
1
Fluid Level
3 4
1. 2. 3. 4. Rubber Boot Rod Adjuster Locknut Top Surface of Turn Buckle Figure 1-13. Pushrod Adjustment
b0613x2x
Figure 1-12. Checking Brake Fluid (Switch shown uncovered for clarity)
1WARNING
Always test motorcycle brakes at low speed after servicing or bleeding system. To prevent death or serious injury, Buell recommends that all brake repairs be performed by a Buell dealer or other qualied mechanic. Check rear brake pedal height.
G G G
Before every ride. At the 500 mile (800 km) service interval. At every 5000 mile (8000 km) service interval thereafter. See Figure 1-13. Slide rubber boot (1) upward. Measure distance from bottom edge of rod adjuster (2) to top surface of turn buckle (4). a. If measurement approximately 0.84 in. (21.3 mm), slide rubber boot (1) down over assembly. Brake pedal adjustment is not needed. If measurement is not within specication, adjust brake pedal. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance
1. 2.
b. 1-18
HOME
1.6
1WARNING
Always replace brake pads in complete sets for correct brake operation. Never replace just one brake pad. Failure to install brake pads as a set could result in death or serious injury. Check brake pads for minimum thickness:
G G
1 3
At the 500 mile (800 km) service interval. At every scheduled service interval thereafter. 1. 2. 3. Friction Material Wear Groove Backing Material Figure 1-15. Brake Pad Thickness
See Figure 1-15. Inspect brake pads for damage or excessive wear. Replace both pads as a set if friction material (1) of either pad is worn to 0.04 in. (1.0 mm) or less. If this amount of wear occurs, wear grooves (2) will disappear from friction material surface.
G
Replace front brake pads using procedure under 2.11 FRONT BRAKE CALIPER. Replace rear brake pads using procedure under 2.14 REAR BRAKE CALIPER.
7997
BRAKE ROTORS
Brake Rotor Thickness
1WARNING
Do not allow brake uid, bearing grease, lubricants, etc. to contact brake rotor or reduced braking ability will occur, which could result in death or serious injury. Check brake rotors for minimum thickness:
G G
At the 500 mile (800 km) service interval. At every scheduled service interval thereafter. Measure rotor thickness. Replace if minimum thickness is less than 0.18 in. (4.5 mm). Check rotor surface. Replace if warped or badly scored. The brake rotor must be within the following specications. If the brake rotor is suspected of being damaged, inspect rotor using the following measurements:
G G G
1.
2. 3.
Lateral Movement: 0.5 mm Radial Movement: 0.45 mm Rotational Movement: 0.39 mm 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance 1-19
HOME
1.7
Before every ride. At the 500 mile (800 km) service interval. At every scheduled service interval.
Check for proper front and rear tire pressures when tires are cold. Compare pressure against Table 1-5.
WHEEL BEARINGS
Check wheel bearings:
G G G
Every time the wheel is removed. At every 10,000 mile (16,000 km) service interval. When storing or removing the motorcycle for the season.
Check wheel bearings and axle spacers for wear and corrosion. Excessive play or roughness indicates worn bearings. Replace bearings in sets only.
1-20
HOME
CLUTCH
TRANSMISSION FLUID
Check transmission uid:
G G
8232
1.8
Replace at the 500 mile (800 km) service interval. Inspect level at every 2500 mile (4000 km) service interval. Replace at every 5000 mile (8000 km) service interval. TORX Screw with Washer (4)
Transmission uid capacity is approximately 1.0 quart (0.95 liter). For best results, drain uid while hot. 1. Raise rear wheel off oor using REAR WHEEL SUPPORT STAND (Part No. B-41174). This prevents transmission uid from spilling out of the clutch inspection cover opening. Remove mufer to access drain plug. See 2.27 EXHAUST SYSTEM. See Figure 1-17. Position a suitable container under drain plug (3). Remove plug and drain uid. Wipe any foreign material from the magnetic drain plug. Reinstall plug. Tighten to 14-21 ft-lbs (19-29 Nm). Remove four TORX screws with washers (1) from clutch inspection cover (2). Remove clutch inspection cover from primary cover. Do not damage or dislodge Quad ring from primary cover. CAUTION Do not overll the transmission with uid. Overlling may cause rough clutch engagement, incomplete disengagement, clutch drag and/or difculty in nding neutral at engine idle. 6. See Figure 1-18. Add SPORT-TRANS FLUID (Part No. 98854-96 quart size; Part No. 98855-96 gallon size) as required until uid level (4) is even with bottom of clutch diaphragm spring (3). See Figure 1-17. Install clutch inspection cover (2) using four TORX screws with washers (1). Tighten in a crosswise pattern to 7-9 ft-lbs (10-12 Nm). Install mufer. See 2.27 EXHAUST SYSTEM. 3. Figure 1-17. Primary Cover
Drain Plug
2. 3. 4. 5.
ADJUSTMENT
Check clutch adjustment:
G G
At the 500 mile (800 km) service interval. At every 5000 mile (8000 km) service interval thereafter.
If clutch slips under load or drags when released, rst check control cable adjustment. If cable adjustment is within specications, adjust clutch mechanism as described below. When necessary, lubricate cable with LUBIT-8 TUFOIL CHAIN AND CABLE LUBE (Part No. HD-94968-85TV). 1. 2. Raise rear wheel off oor using REAR WHEEL SUPPORT STAND (Part No. B-41174). See Figure 1-19. Slide rubber boot upward to expose adjuster mechanism. Loosen jam nut from adjuster. Turn adjuster to shorten cable housing until there is a large amount of freeplay at clutch hand lever. See Figure 1-20. Remove four TORX screws with washers (1) from clutch inspection cover (2). Remove clutch inspection cover from primary cover. Do not damage or dislodge Quad ring (3) from primary cover.
7.
8.
b0190a6x
NOTE Quad ring is shown removed from primary cover for illustrative purposes only in Figure 1-20. 4. 5. Remove spring (4) and lockplate (5). Turn adjusting screw (6) counterclockwise until it lightly bottoms. Turn adjusting screw (6) clockwise 1/4 turn. Install lockplate (5) and spring (4) on adjusting screw ats. If hex on lockplate does not align with recess in outer ramp, rotate adjusting screw clockwise until it aligns. Squeeze clutch hand lever to maximum limit three times. This sets the ball and ramp mechanism. Pull outer cable conduit and at the same time adjust cable adjuster to provide 1/16-1/8 in. (1.6-3.2 mm) freeplay at clutch hand lever. Adjust as follows. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance 1-21
6. Fluid Level
HOME a. See Figure 1-21. Pull ferrule (1) (end of cable housing) away from bracket (2). Gap between ferrule and bracket should be 1/16-1/8 in. (1.6-3.2 mm). See Figure 1-19. Set freeplay by turning adjuster. Tighten jam nut against adjuster. Slide boot over cable adjuster mechanism. Ferrule
b0289x6x
b. c. d. 7. 8.
Change or add transmission uid if necessary. See Figure 1-20. Install clutch inspection cover (2) using four TORX screws with washers (1). Tighten in a crosswise pattern to 7-9 ft-lbs (10-12 Nm). Check clutch cable freeplay. See Step 6 above.
9.
Figure 1-21. Adjusting Clutch Freeplay Rubber Boot Cable End Jam Nut
b0267x8x
6 2
5 3
1. 2. 3.
1-22
HOME
1.9
Inspect before every ride. Adjust at the 500 mile (800 km) service interval. Inspect at every 5000 mile (8000 km) service interval thereafter. NOTE 1.5-1.75 in. (38.1-44.5 mm) 10 lbs force
There are tight and loose spots during rear wheel rotation that affect belt deection. For a more precise measurement, take three deection readings, rotating the rear wheel between measurements. Average the three readings for a more precise measurement. When checking deection, have:
G G G G
b0086a6x
b0609x6x
1
No rider or cargo weight on motorcycle. Transmission in neutral. Belt and sprockets at room temperature. Motorcycle upright (not on side stand). Adjust rear shock absorber spring preload. Detach drive support arm and sprocket cover. Unload the rear suspension by lifting the motorcycle frame under the tail section. NOTE When the rear suspension is fully unloaded, the motorcycles weight is not compressing the rear shock. It is not necessary to raise the rear wheel off the ground to reach this point. 4. See Figure 1-22. Apply 10 lbs of force to belt at midpoint of bottom strand using BELT TENSION GAUGE (Part No. HD-35381). The deection should be upwards as shown. a. Deection (measured with 10 lbs of force) should be 1.50-1.75 in. (38.1-44.5 mm) at the bottom strand. If deection is within limits, see ADJUSTMENT, Axle Alignment. If belt tension does require adjustment, see ADJUSTMENT, Deection Adjustment. After adjusting deection, check axle alignment. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
1. 2. 3.
4 5
Rear Wheel Sprocket Drive Belt Transmission Sprocket Location to Apply Force Location to Measure Belt Deection Figure 1-22. Checking Belt Deection
6851
b.
Axle Carrier
5.
Install drive support arm and sprocket cover. a. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 272 (red) to drive support screws. Tighten screws to 20-25 ft-lbs (27-34 Nm). Tighten drive support nut to 35 ft-lbs (40-47 Nm). Axle Nut (metric) Figure 1-23. Rear Axle Adjuster
b.
1-23
HOME
ADJUSTMENT
Axle Alignment
Check to be sure rear wheel axle is parallel with swingarm pivot shaft. 1. See Figure 1-24. Measure each side from the at of the axle carrier to the at of the swingarm. a. b. If the measurements are equal +/- 0.015 in. (.381 mm) the rear axle is correctly aligned. If the two measurements are not equal, adjustment is required. Follow below.
6852
Locknut
Adjusting Nut
Deection Adjustment
1. See Figure 1-23. Loosen rear axle nut (metric), if not already loose. NOTE See Figure 1-25. Use an automotive-style ignition wrench to hold axle adjuster bolt in place during Step 2. 2. To adjust belt deection/rear wheel alignment, loosen locknut, hold axle adjuster bolt and turn adjusting nut. a. b. If belt is too loose, tighten adjusting nut to decrease deection and therefore increase drive belt tension. If belt is too tight, loosen adjusting nut to increase belt deection and therefore decrease drive belt tension. See Figure 1-25. Repeat this step until the distance between the at on the axle carrier and the at of the swingarm is the same on both sides of the rear wheel and belt deection is correct. Figure 1-25. Axle Adjuster Bolt, Right Side Shown
c.
3. 4. 5.
Tighten locknut flush against adjusting nut. Tighten axle nut (metric) to 66-73 ft-lbs (90-99 Nm). Verify that belt deection is correct.
6816
1-24
HOME
1.10
Drive Belt
See Figure 1-26. Inspect drive belt for:
G G
At the 500 mile (800 km) service interval. At every 5000 mile (8000 km) service interval thereafter.
Cuts or unusual wear patterns. Outside edge bevelling (8). Some bevelling is common, but it indicates that sprockets are misaligned. Outside ribbed surface for signs of stone puncture (7). If cracks/damage exists near edge of belt, replace belt immediately. Damage to center of belt will require belt replacement eventually, but when cracks extend to edge of belt, belt failure is imminent. Inside (toothed portion) of belt for exposed tensile cords (normally covered by nylon layer and polyethylene layer). This condition will result in belt failure and indicates worn transmission sprocket teeth. Replace belt and transmission sprocket. Signs of puncture or cracking at the base of the belt teeth. Replace belt if either condition exists. Replace belt if conditions 2, 3, 6 or 7 (on edge of belt) exist.
NOTE When a drive belt is replaced for any reason other than stone damage, it is recommended that the transmission and rear sprockets also be replaced to increase the longevity of the new drive belt. In the case of stone damage, inspect sprockets for damage and replace as required.
INSPECTION
Rear Sprocket
NOTE If chrome chips or gouges to rear sprocket are large enough to be harmful, they will leave a pattern on the belt face. 1. Inspect each tooth of rear sprocket for: a. b. c. d. 2. Major tooth damage. Large chrome chips with sharp edges. Gouges caused by hard objects. Excessive loss of chrome plating (see Step 2).
G
NOTE Condition 1 may develop into 2 or 3 over time. Condition 1 is not grounds for replacing the belt, but it should be watched closely before condition 2 develops which will required belt replacement.
To check if chrome plating has worn off, drag a scribe or sharp knife point across the bottom of a groove between two teeth with medium pressure. a. If scribe or knife point slides across groove without digging in or leaving a visible mark, chrome plating is still good. If scribe or knife points digs in and leaves a visible mark, it is cutting the bare aluminum. A knife point will not penetrate the chrome plating.
CLEANING
Keep dirt, grease, oil, and debris off the belt and sprockets. Clean the drive belt with a spray solution of mild soap and water. Wipe the solution off the belt and dry. Do not immerse the belt in the soapy water solution.
b.
3.
1-25
HOME
b0086a6x
1-26
HOME
PRIMARY CHAIN
INSPECTION
Check primary chain tension:
G G
b0333x1x
1.11
6
At the 500 mile (800 km) service interval. At every 5000 mile (8000 km) service interval thereafter.
See Figure 1-27. Measure primary chain tension through the inspection cover (3) opening. Adjust primary chains not meeting vertical freeplay specications. 1. 2. 3. See Figure 1-27. Remove two screws (1) and O-rings (2). Remove inspection cover (3) and O-ring (4) from primary cover (6). See Figure 1-28. Check primary chain tension by measuring vertical freeplay (4). a. b. c. Measure vertical freeplay through inspection cover opening (2). Rotate engine to move primary chain to a different position on sprockets (1, 3). Measure vertical freeplay several times, each time with primary chain moved so that the measurement is taken with sprockets rotated to the tightest chain position.
1
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
4 5
Screw (2) O-Ring (2) Inspection Cover O-Ring Adjusting Screw and Locknut Primary Cover Figure 1-27.
4.
The tightest measurement taken in Step 3 must be within the specications listed in Table 1-6. If necessary, adjust as described under ADJUSTMENT.
NOTE The initial primary chain vertical freeplay specication used at the assembly plant is 1/4-1/2 in. (6.4-12.7 mm) with a cold engine. The 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) minimum is only allowed at the absolute tightest point in the drive, as measured with specialized factory equipment. If a chain has less than 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) vertical freeplay (with a cold engine), adjust freeplay to the eld specication of 3/8-1/2 in. (9.5-12.7 mm). The looser specication will avoid overtightening, which might otherwise occur during adjustment using non-factory equipment and methods. 5. 6. See Figure 1-27. Install O-ring (4). Fasten inspection cover (3) to primary cover (6) using two screws (1) with O-rings (2). Tighten to 40-60 in-lbs (5-7 Nm).
ADJUSTMENT
NOTE If vertical freeplay cannot be set within the limits specied, then primary chain and/or chain adjuster are worn beyond adjustment limits. Replace parts as necessary. See Section 6. 1. 2. See Figure 1-29. Loosen locknut (1). Turn adjusting screw (2): a. b. 3. Clockwise (inward) to reduce freeplay. Counterclockwise (outward) to increase freeplay.
1-27
HOME
b0085a6x
3 4
1. 2. 3. 4.
Engine Sprocket Inspection Cover Opening Clutch Sprocket Vertical Freeplay Figure 1-28. Measuring Primary Chain Tension
8232
1-28
HOME
PRELOAD ADJUSTMENT
GENERAL
b0855x2x
1.12
When the new owner takes delivery of the motorcycle. When there is a change in load (adding luggage, etc.). Before changing front fork or rear shock suspension settings.
Optimal rear suspension spring preload assures that the rear shock has enough travel to absorb bumps without bottoming. Spring preload is the most important suspension adjustment. Improper preload of the motorcycle will adversely affect both the handling and ride. Correct preload setting will result in motorcycle handling that suits the riders size and weight. Preload Measurement (Rider Seated on Motorcycle) S3/S3T Models: 15.2-15.5 in. (386-394 mm) Figure 1-30. Measuring Preload
ADJUSTMENT
Rear Shock
1. See Figure 1-30. Check and adjust rear shock preload. a. With rider seated on motorcycle, the preload is determined by measuring the distance between the centers of the front and rear shock eye and adjusting until the measurement is within specication. See below for optimum preload measurement: S3/S3T Models: 15.2-15.5 in. (386-394 mm)
b.
G
NOTE: All measurements must be taken with rider seated on motorcycle. Riders with passenger at or near GVWR may exceed optimum preload adjustment. See Figure 1-31. To adjust shock preload, loosen the locknut and turn the preload adjuster at the end of the shock to move the canister towards the front or rear of the motorcycle. a. b. Move canister towards rear of motorcycle to increase preload. Move canister towards front of motorcycle to decrease preload.
2.
3.
See Figure 1-32. When nished, apply wheel bearing grease halfway around the shock (180 degrees) to the mating faces of the locknut and adjuster nut and the rst few threads on the aluminum body leading to the adjuster nut. Thread locknut back into place.
4.
NOTE Torque wrench and crows foot must be set at 90 degrees to prevent torque multiplication by wrench. 5. Using SHOCK PRELOAD ADJUSTING TOOLS (Part No. B-45110), hold adjusting nut in place with 60 mm ADJUSTING NUT WRENCH and tighten locknut to 6572 ft-lbs (88-98 Nm) with 52 mm LOCKNUT CROWS FOOT set at 90 degrees to the torque wrench. Wipe excess grease off of shock absorber. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance 1-29
6.
HOME
b00851x2x
TOP VIEW
Rear of Motorcycle
b0921x2x
Locknut Preload Adjuster Figure 1-31. Rear Shock Preload Adjustment Locknut Grease
Adjusting Nut
Apply grease to shaded areas (halfway around shock) to mating faces of nuts and to leading threads. Figure 1-32. Locknut Tightening Procedure NOTE When preload is increased, compression damping should be increased. If preload is decreased, compression damping should be decreased.
1-30
HOME
1.13
Rebound Adjuster
1WARNING
Always adjust each fork leg to the same settings. Uneven adjustment between left and right forks may lead to a loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. Verify that all suspension settings are adjusted to the factory recommended standards. 1. Using a screwdriver, turn the slotted dial on the appropriate adjuster clockwise until it stops. This is the maximum damping setting for that adjustment. Then turn the dial counterclockwise the recommended amount to align the reference marks (dots). This is the factory recommended setting.
b558xox
Compression Adjuster
2.
See Figure 1-33. Factory setting = maximum damping minus 2.5 turns. Figure 1-33. Front Forks
See Figure 1-34. Adjust rebound damping using the slotted dial on the remote reservoir at the front of the shock. Factory setting = maximum damping minus 1 turn.
b0854x2x
2.
SETTINGS
Front Rebound Front Compression Rear Rebound Rear Compression
SOLO (STD)
0.5 1.75 1 2.5
2-UP
1 1.25 0.5 0.25
SOLO (FIRM)
0.5 1.25 0.5 1
SOLO (SOFT)
1.5 MIN 2.5 MIN 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance 1-31
HOME
b00851x2x
1-32
HOME
FRONT FORK
FORK OIL CHANGE
Replace fork oil:
G G
b0666x2x
1.14
2
At every 20,000 mile (32,000 km) service interval. If fork should be submerged in water.
NOTE If fork oil is emulsied, aerated or light brown in color, then it has been contaminated by water. If this happens, replace the fork oil seals. 1. Remove, drain and disassemble front forks. Inspect and assemble parts as described under 2.16 FRONT FORK.
3
3.15 in. (80 mm)
NOTE Use only TYPE E FORK OIL (Part No. HD-99884-80). 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. See Table 1-7. While supporting fork, pour one-half of the recommended amount of fork oil into fork pipe. See Figure 1-36. Pump damper assembly (3) and leg slowly about 10 times, using 6.0 in. (150 mm) strokes. Place damper assembly and outer tube in full bottomed position. Pour remaining amount of recommended fork oil into fork pipe. Check fork oil level. Maximum and minimum oil levels are listed in Table 1-7. a. b. With front fork fully compressed, clamp vertically in FRONT FORK HOLDING TOOL (Part No. B-41177). Measure distance from fork oil (4) surface to top of outer tube (1) using PRO-LEVEL OIL GAUGE (Part No. B-59000A). See Figure 1-37. Add or drain fork oil as needed until distance from top of fork tube to oil surface measures 3.15 in. (80.0 mm). 1. 2. 3. 4.
Outer Tube Adjuster Damper Assembly Fork Oil Level Figure 1-36. Correct Fork Oil Level
c.
NOTE Left and right forks must contain equal amounts of fork oil. 7. Finish fork assembly and install. See 2.16 FRONT FORK.
b05900a
Figure 1-37. Pro Level Oil Gauge 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance 1-33
HOME
1.15
Inspect at the 500 mile (800 km) service interval. Inspect and adjust at every 2500 mile (4000 km) service interval thereafter. Inspect when storing or removing the motorcycle for the season. Inspect, adjust and lubricate at every 10,000 mile (16,000 km) service interval. See Figure 1-38. Raise front wheel off oor using FRONT WHEEL SUPPORT STAND (Part No. B-41395A) and LIFT ADAPTER (Part No. B-43426-1) Turn front wheel to full right lock. Hook a spring scale into the hole in the front axle. Pull front wheel to center position. It should take 4.5-6.5 lbs (2.0-2.9 kg) to pull front wheel to center. NOTE Figure 1-38. Checking Steering Head Bearings (Typical)
b0373x2x
1.
2. 3.
1 8 2 9
Check that clutch and throttle cables do not bind when measuring bearing resistance. If binding occurs, detach cables and re-attach when complete.
Lubrication
At 10,000 miles (16,000 km) and every 10,000 miles (16,000 km) thereafter, lubricate the steering head bearings with WHEEL BEARING GREASE (Part No. 99855-89). See 2.17 FORK STEM AND BRACKET ASSEMBLY for lubrication procedure.
3 4 5 5 4 3
ADJUSTMENT
1. Test motorcycle according to procedure listed under INSPECTION. If adjustment is needed, follow the instructions below. See Figure 1-39. Loosen both pinch screws (7) on lower triple clamp. Loosen small pinch screw (8) on upper triple clamp. Tighten or loosen fork stem bolt (1) to set proper tension. Recheck tension using spring scale. See Steps 2 and 3 of INSPECTION. Tighten both lower triple clamp pinch screws (7) to 18-20 ft-lbs (24-27 Nm). Tighten small pinch screw (8) on upper triple clamp to 10-12 ft-lbs (14-16 Nm). 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Fork Stem Bolt Upper Triple Clamp Dust Shield (2) Roller Bearing (2) Bearing Cup (2) Lower Triple Clamp 7. 8. 9. Lower Pinch Screws (2) Pinch Screw Upper Pinch Screws (2)
6 7
2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
1-34
HOME
SPARK PLUGS
INSPECTION
Check spark plugs:
G G G
4636
1.16
Inspect at every 5000 mile (8000 km) service interval. Replace every 10,000 mile (16,000 km) service interval. Use only Harley-Davidson 10R12 spark plugs (Part No. 27661-00Y). Disconnect cables from both spark plugs. Remove spark plugs. See Figure 1-40. Compare your observations of the plug deposits with the descriptions provided below. a. A wet, black and shiny deposit on plug base, electrodes and ceramic insulator tip indicates an oil fouled plug. The condition may be caused by one or more of the following: worn pistons, worn piston rings, worn valves, worn valve guides, worn valve seals, a weak battery or a faulty ignition system. A dry, uffy or sooty black deposit indicates a carburetor air-fuel mixture that is too rich, engine idling for excessive periods of time and/or enrichener usage for excessive periods of time. A light brown, glassy deposit indicates an overheated plug. This condition may be accompanied by cracks in the insulator or by erosion of the electrodes and is caused by an air-fuel mixture that is too lean, a hot-running engine, valves not seating or improper ignition timing. The glassy deposit on the spark plug is a conductor when hot and may cause high-speed misring. A plug with eroded electrodes, heavy deposits or a cracked insulator must be replaced. A plug with a white, yellow, tan or rusty brown powdery deposit indicates balanced combustion. Clean off spark plug deposits at regular intervals. 11-18 ft-lbs (15-24 Nm) Anti-Seize Figure 1-41. Spark Plugs (Typical)
1. 2. 3.
b.
c.
d.
4.
If the plugs require cleaning between tune-ups and replacement plugs are not available, proceed as follows: a. Degrease ring end of spark plug using ELECTRICAL CONTACT CLEANER. Dry plug with compressed air. Use a thin le to atten spark plug electrodes. A spark plug with sharp edges on its electrodes requires 25%-40% less ring voltage than one with rounded edges.
b.
5. 6. 7.
If the plugs cannot be cleaned, replace with No. 10R12 spark plugs. Check electrode gap with a wire-type feeler gauge. Gap should be 0.038-0.043 in. (0.97-1.09 mm). See Figure 1-41. Apply LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE to rst few threads of spark plugs. Install and tighten to 11-18 ftlbs (15-24 Nm). Connect spark plug cables. Longer cable attaches to rear cylinder spark plug. Verify that cables are securely connected to coil and spark plugs.
8.
1-35
HOME
AIR CLEANER
REMOVAL
Check air cleaner lter element:
G G
7158
1.17
3 1
Inspect at the 500 mile (800 km) service interval. Replace at every 5000 mile (8000 km) service interval thereafter. NOTE
Service air cleaner lter element more often if the motorcycle is run in a dusty environment.
CAUTION Do not run engine without lter element in place. Debris may be drawn into the engine causing damage. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. See Figure 1-42. Remove both front screws and nylon washers (2). On S3T models, remove bolt and washer holding right fairing lower to bracket on swingarm/drive support. Remove both rear screws and nylon washers (1). Remove cover (3) with attached fairing lower if present. See Figure 1-43. Remove bolts and washers (3) from lter box (2). Slide lter box forward, away from snorkel (1). See Figure 1-44. Remove the lter element (2) from lter box (1). Inspect and replace if necessary.
1. 2. 3.
Rear Screw and Nylon Washer (2) Front Screw and Nylon Washer (2) Cover Figure 1-42. Air Cleaner Cover
7156
4 1 2 3
INSTALLATION 1WARNING
Do not use gasoline or solvents to clean the lter element. Volatile/ammable cleaning agents may cause an intake system re which could result in death or serious injury. 1. Check lter element. Hold lter element up to strong light source. The element can be considered sufciently clean if light is uniformly visible through the element. Thoroughly clean backplate, lter box and inside of cover. See Figure 1-44. Place lter element (2) in lter box (1). Attach lter box to snorkel. See Figure 1-43. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 243 (blue) to bolts (3). Fasten lter box to backplate with bolts and washers (3). See Figure 1-42. Place cover (3) over backplate assembly. Install both rear screws and nylon washers (1). Install both front screws and nylon washers (2). On S3T models, install bolt and washer to fasten right fairing lower to bracket on swingarm/drive support. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance Figure 1-44. Filter Element 1. 2. Snorkel Filter Box 3. 4. Bolt and Washer (2) IAT Sensor
6178
Filter Box
Filter Element
2. 3. 4.
5. 6. 7.
1-36
HOME
IGNITION TIMING
INSPECTION
Check ignition timing:
G
b0637x7x
1.18
At every 5000 mile (8000 km) service interval use the STATIC TIMING method. After each removal of the cam position sensor.
Bolt
b.
c. 2. 3.
Remove seat and tail section to gain access to electronic control module. See 2.33 TAIL SECTION. Prepare vehicle for testing. a. Remove the timing plug from the timing inspection hole centered below the cylinders on the right side of the crankcase. Remove the spark plugs. Jack up vehicle to allow rotation of the rear wheel. Shift transmission into fth gear. Standing on left side of vehicle, slowly rotate rear wheel in a counter-clockwise direction until front intake valve opens and closes (as viewed through spark plug holes). See Figure 1-46. Rotate rear wheel until TDC mark is centered in timing inspection hole. Unplug gray connector [11] on electronic control module. Attach female gray connector on BREAKOUT BOX (Part No. HD-42682) to electronic control module. Attach male gray connector on BREAKOUT BOX to wiring harness. Connect red (+) lead on voltmeter to Pin 3 on gray side of BREAKOUT BOX. Connect black (-) lead on voltmeter to Pin 8 on gray side of BREAKOUT BOX.
Front Cylinder Top Dead Center (TDC) Figure 1-46. Timing Marks
b. c. d. 4. a.
b. 5.
1-37
HOME
b0636x7x
VDC
1 6 11
2 7
3 8
4 9
5 10 12
Blac
2 7 3 8 4 9
Connector [10]
Connector [11]
1 6 11
5 10 12
Gray
Figure 1-47. Static Timing Connections 6. See Figure 1-48. Set static timing. This will align openings (1, 2) on trigger cup with cam position sensor. a. b. c. Set engine stop switch to RUN. Turn ignition switch to IGN. See Figure 1-47. Loosen two screws (5) on cam position sensor (7). Rotate sensor clockwise until the voltmeter registers the change from 0.0-1.0 VDC to 5.0 VDC (+/- 0.5 volts). Tighten both sensor screws (5) to 15-30 in-lbs (2-3 Nm).
d. 7. 8. 9.
Install inner cover (4), inner cover screws (3), outer cover (2) and new outer cover rivets (1). Install spark plugs, shift transmission into neutral and remove jack. Remove BREAKOUT BOX harness and connect electronic control module connector [11].
1. 2. 3.
Large Opening Small Opening Front Cylinder Top Dead Center Window Figure 1-48. Trigger Cup Openings (Cam Position Sensor Removed For Illustration)
1WARNING
After installing seat, pull upward on front of seat to be sure it is locked in position. If seat is loose, it could shift during vehicle operation and startle the rider, causing loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 10. Install seat and tail section. See 2.33 TAIL SECTION.
1-38
HOME
HANDLEBARS
INSPECTION
Check handlebar adjustment:
G
6088
1.19
1WARNING
Handlebars must not touch front forks or gas tank. Improperly adjusted handlebars may cause loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 1. See Figure 1-49. Check steering motion range to both fork stops. Handlebars should not make contact with the front forks, fuel tank or fairing.
6089
2.
Handlebars should be equally spaced between outside edge of handlebar clamp and inside edge of mirror mounts.
ADJUSTMENT
CAUTION Never adjust handlebars using excessive force or damage to handlebars might result. 1. 2. 3. See Figure 1-50. Loosen clamp screws (1, 2).
6286
Move handlebar to desired position. Tighten clamp screws to 10-12 ft-lbs (14-16 Nm). NOTE
First tighten the front clamp screws (1) to 10-12 ft-lbs (14-16 Nm). Once the front clamp screws are tight, tighten the rear clamp screws to 10-12 ft-lbs (14-16 Nm).
1WARNING
Handlebars must not touch front forks or gas tank. Improperly adjusted handlebars may cause loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 4. Check steering motion range to both fork stops. Handlebars should not make contact with the front forks, fuel tank or fairing. If handlebar needs further adjustment, repeat adjustment beginning with Step 1. 1. 2. Front Clamp Screws (2) Rear Clamp Screws (2) Figure 1-50. Adjusting Handlebars
1-39
HOME
THROTTLE CABLES
ADJUSTMENT 1WARNING
Throttle cables must not pull tight when handlebars are turned fully to left or right fork stops. Make sure wires and throttle cables are clear of fork stops at steering head so they will not be pinched when fork is turned against stops. Steering must be smooth and free with no binding or interference. Anything interfering with throttle operation or steering may cause loss of vehicle control which could result in death or serious injury. Check throttle cable adjustment:
G G
6853
1.20
3 4 1 5 2
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Throttle Control Cable Idle Control Cable Cable Adjuster Lock Cable Adjuster Rubber Boot
Check throttle cable adjustment with engine running. Turn handlebars through full range of travel. If engine speed changes during this maneuver, adjust throttle cables as follows: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Remove air cleaner cover and backplate. See 4.41 AIR CLEANER. See Figure 1-51. Slide rubber boot (5) off each cable adjuster (4). Loosen cable adjuster lock (3) on each cable (1, 2). Turn adjusters in direction which will shorten cable housings to minimum length. Point front wheel straight ahead. Twist throttle control grip to fully open position; hold in position. See Figure 1-52. Turn adjuster on throttle control cable until throttle cam stop (5) touches stop plate. Tighten jam nut on throttle control cable adjuster; release throttle control grip. Turn handlebars fully to right. Turn adjuster on idle control cable (3) until end of cable housing just touches the cable guide (2). See Figure 1-51. Twist and release throttle control grip a few times. Throttle plate must return to idle position each time throttle grip is released. If this is not the case, turn adjuster (4) on idle control cable (2) (shortening cable housing) until throttle control functions properly. Tighten cable adjuster lock (3) on idle control cable (2). Recheck operation of throttle control.
6955
3 4
7.
8.
9.
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Guide for Throttle Control Cable Guide for Idle Control Cable Idle Control Cable Idle Adjustment Screw (Typical) Throttle Cam Stop Figure 1-52. Throttle Body Manifold (Typical)
10. Slide rubber boot (5) over each cable adjuster (4). Recheck engine slow idle speed; adjust if required. 11. Install air cleaner assembly. See 4.41 AIR CLEANER.
IDLE ADJUSTMENT
Check idle adjustment:
G G
Regular idle speed is 850-1050 RPM. Set idle speed using idle adjuster and tachometer. 1-40 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance
HOME
HEADLAMP
INSPECTION 1WARNING
DO NOT modify the ignition/headlamp switch wiring to circumvent the automatic-on headlamp feature. Riding without an operating headlamp could cause an accident. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. Check headlamp for proper height and lateral alignment:
G G
b0008c7x
1.21
32 in. (81.3 cm)
When the new owner takes delivery of the motorcycle. When there is a change in load (adding luggage, etc.) Verify correct front and rear tire pressure. See 1.7 TIRES AND WHEELS. Place motorcycle on level oor (or pavement) in an area with minimum light. See Figure 1-53. Position motorcycle 25 ft (7.62 meters) away from a screen or wall. Measure the distance from directly below the front axle to the base of the screen/ wall. Draw a horizontal line 32 in. (81.3 cm) above oor on screen/wall. Load vehicle with rider/passenger/cargo/accessories. Weight will compress vehicle suspension slightly. Stand motorcycle upright with both tires resting on oor and with front wheel held in straight alignment (directly forward). Turn ignition switch to IGN. Set handlebar headlamp switch to HIGH beam position. Check light beam for alignment. a. The main beam, which is a broad, at pattern of light, should be centered equally above and below the horizontal line. The main beam of light should also be directed straight ahead. Properly adjusted headlamps project an equal area of light to right and left of center. Adjust headlamp alignment if necessary. See ADJUSTMENT.
6239 b0273box
1. 2. 3.
4. 5. 6.
7. 8.
b.
c.
ADJUSTMENT
If headlamp requires adjustment, perform the following: 1. Change height alignment by tilting headlamp up or down to aim it in relation to the horizontal line in Figure 1-53. a. b. 2. See Figure 1-54. Turn headlamp adjuster clockwise to raise beam. Turn headlamp adjuster counterclockwise to lower beam.
See Figure 1-55. Change lateral alignment by adjusting the right side headlamp mounting stud with a nut driver. a. b. Turn stud clockwise to shift headlamp beam to the right. Turn stud counterclockwise to shift headlamp beam to the left.
1-41
HOME
STORAGE
GENERAL
If the motorcycle will not be operated for several months, such as during the winter season, there are several things which should be done to protect parts against corrosion, to preserve the battery and to prevent the buildup of gum and varnish in the fuel system. This work should be performed by your local Buell dealer following Service Manual procedures.
1.22
REMOVAL FROM STORAGE 1WARNING
After extended periods of storage and prior to starting vehicle, place transmission in gear, disengage clutch and push vehicle back and forth a few times to ensure proper clutch disengagement. Improper clutch disengagement while vehicle is in motion may cause an accident which could result in death or serious injury. 1. Charge and install battery. See 1.3 BATTERY. Remove and inspect spark plugs. Replace if necessary. See 1.16 SPARK PLUGS. Inspect air lter element. Replace if necessary. See 1.17 AIR CLEANER. If fuel tank was drained, ll fuel tank with fresh gasoline. If oil feed line was pinched off or plugged, unplug it and reconnect. Start the engine and run until it reaches normal operating temperature. Check uids and rell to proper levels if required. a. b. 7. Check engine oil level. See 1.3 BATTERY. Check transmission uid level. See 1.8 CLUTCH. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
1WARNING
Gasoline is ammable. Do not store motorcycle having gasoline in tank within the home or garage where open ames, pilot lights, sparks or electric motors are present. Inadequate safety precautions may result in a re or explosion which could result in death or serious injury. 1. Fill fuel tank and add a gasoline stabilizer. Use one of the commercially available gasoline stabilizers following the manufacturers instructions. Run engine until gasoline has had a chance to reach fuel injectors. Fill the oil tank. See 1.3 BATTERY. Pinch off (or remove and plug) the line leading from the oil tank bottom to the oil pump feed tting. This prevents oil from seeping past the check ball into the oil pump and lling the engine ywheel compartment. Remove battery and charge as needed to maintain the correct voltage. See 1.3 BATTERY. Remove the spark plugs, inject a few squirts of engine oil into each cylinder and crank the engine 5-6 revolutions. Reinstall spark plugs. See 1.16 SPARK PLUGS. Adjust rear drive belt deection. See 1.9 DRIVE BELT DEFLECTION. Adjust primary chain. See 1.11 PRIMARY CHAIN. Check tire ination. See 1.7 TIRES AND WHEELS. If the motorcycle will be stored for an extended period of time, securely support the motorcycle under the frame so that all weight is off the tires.
2.
Perform all of the checks in the PRE-RIDING CHECK LIST in the Owners Manual.
3.
4.
5.
6. 7.
1WARNING
Do not apply any oil to brake rotors or brake pads. Oil on brake pads degrades braking efciency and may cause an accident which could result in death or serious injury. 8. Wash painted and chrome-plated surfaces. Apply a light lm of oil to exposed unpainted surfaces. If motorcycle is to be covered, use a material that will breathe, such as light canvas. Plastic materials that do not breathe promote the formation of condensation. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance
9.
1-42
HOME
TROUBLESHOOTING
GENERAL
The following check list can be helpful in locating most operating troubles. Refer to the appropriate sections in this Service Manual for detailed procedures. 10. Air leak at intake manifold. 11. Valves sticking.
1.23
ENGINE
Starter Motor Does Not Operate or Does Not Turn Engine Over
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Engine stop switch in OFF position. Ignition key switch not ON. Discharged battery or loose or corroded connections. (Solenoid chatters.) Starter control relay or solenoid not functioning. Electric starter shaft pinion gear not engaging or overrunning clutch slipping.
10. Intermittent short circuit due to damaged wire insulation. 11. Water or dirt in fuel system/partially clogged fuel lter/ injector. 12. Vapor vent valve plugged or carburetor oat bowl vent closed off. 13. TPS and/or fast idle screw not set properly. See dealer. 14. Inoperative fuel injector. See dealer. 15. Air leak at intake manifold or air lter. 16. Damaged intake or exhaust valve. 17. Weak or broken valve springs. 18. Incorrect valve timing.
10. No output from the ECM. See dealer. 11. TPS/fast idle screw not set properly. See dealer. 12. Ignition coil not functioning. 13. No output from CMP sensor. See dealer. 14. Sticking or damaged valve or valves. 15. Engine oil too heavy (winter operation).
Starts Hard
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. Spark plugs in bad condition, have improper gap or are partially fouled. Spark plug cables in bad condition and shorting. Battery nearly discharged. Loose wire connection at one of the battery terminals, at coil or at plug between ignition sensor and module. TPS and/or fast idle screw not set properly. See dealer. O2, IAT or ET sensors damaged or malfunctioning. See dealer. Ignition coil not functioning. Engine oil too heavy (winter operation). Water or dirt in fuel system/clogged fuel lter/injector.
Overheating
1. 2. 3. 4. Insufcient oil supply or oil not circulating. Leaking valves. Heavy carbon deposit. Ignition timing retarded. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Maintenance 1-43
HOME
3. 4. 5.
FUEL
Poor Fuel Economy
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Excessive pumping of throttle control grip. O2 sensor damaged or malfunctioning (bike running rich). See dealer. Inlet valve sticking. Inlet valve and/or valve seat worn or damaged. Dirt or other foreign matter between valve and its seat.
Excessive Vibration
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Engine tie-bars loose, broken or improperly spaced. Lower mounting bolts loose. Broken frame. Primary chain badly worn or links tight as a result of insufcient lubrication. Wheels not aligned and/or tires worn. Internal engine problem.
TRANSMISSION
Shifts Hard
1. Clutch dragging slightly. Shifter forks (inside transmission) damaged. Corners worn off shifter clutch dogs (inside transmission). 2. 3.
CLUTCH
Slips
1. 2. Clutch controls improperly adjusted. Worn friction plates.
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Alternator Does Not Charge
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Regulator-rectier module not functioning. Rectier not grounded. Engine ground wire loose or broken. Loose or broken wires in charging circuit. Stator not functioning. Rotor not functioning.
Chatters
1. Friction or steel plates worn, warped or dragging.
CHASSIS
Irregular/Inadequate Brake Action
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Master cylinder low on uid. Brake line contains air bubbles. Master or wheel cylinder piston worn. Brake pads covered with grease or oil. Brake pads badly worn to minimum lining thickness. Brake rotor badly worn or warped.
1-44
HOME 7. 8. Brake pads dragging or excessive braking (brake fades due to heat buildup). Insufcient brake pedal or hand lever freeplay (brake drags).
Handling Irregularities
1. 2. Tires improperly inated. See 1.7 TIRES AND WHEELS. Do not overinate. Loose wheel axle nuts (metric). Tighten front nut to 4853 ft-lbs (65-72 Nm). Tighten rear nut to 66-73 ft-lbs (9099 Nm). Excessive wheel hub bearing play. Rear wheel out of alignment with frame and front wheel. Rims and tires out-of-true sideways (tire runout should not be more than 0.080 in. (2.03 mm)). Rims and tires out-of-round or eccentric with hub (tire runout should not be more than 0.090 in. (2.29 mm)). Irregular or peaked front tire tread wear. Tire and wheel unbalanced. Steering head bearings improperly adjusted. See 1.15 STEERING HEAD BEARINGS. Correct adjustment and replace pitted or worn bearings and races. See 2.17 FORK STEM AND BRACKET ASSEMBLY.
3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9.
10. Shock absorber not functioning normally. 11. Heavy front end loading. Non-standard equipment on the front end (such as heavy radio receivers, extra lighting equipment or luggage) tends to cause unstable handling.
1-45
HOME
NOTES
1-46
Table Of Contents
CHASSIS
SUBJECT PAGE NO. 2-1 2-4 2-5 2-6 2-8 2-10 2-12 2-13 2-16 2-18 2-21 2-24 2-25 2-28 2-30 2-32 2-37 2-38 2-39 2-43 2-47 2-49 2-50 2-53 2-55 2-57 2-58 2-62 2-63 2-64 2-65 2-66 2-67 2-69 2-71 2-73 2-74 2-76
2.1 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2 Tire Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3 Vehicle Identification Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4 Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5 Front Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.6 Rear Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.7 Checking Cast Rim Runout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.8 Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.9 Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.10 Front Brake Master Cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.11 Front Brake Caliper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.12 Front Brake Line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.13 Rear Brake Master Cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.14 Rear Brake Caliper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.15 Rear Brake Line and Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.16 Front Fork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.17 Fork Stem and Bracket Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.18 Steering Head Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.19 Swingarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.20 Rear Isolators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.21 Rear Shock Absorber . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.22 Suspension Theory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.23 Suspension Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.24 Throttle Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.25 Clutch Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.26 Handlebars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.27 Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.28 Footrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.29 Sprocket Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.30 Stone Guard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.31 Front Fender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.32 Rear Fender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.33 Tail Section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.34 Front Fairing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.35 Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.36 Side Stand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.37 Saddlebags (S3T Models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.38 Fairing Lowers (S3T Models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
HOME
SPECIFICATIONS
DIMENSIONS Wheel Base Seat Height Road Clearance Front Wheel Travel Rear Wheel Travel Trail Rake IN. 55 29.5 5.2 4.7 4.6 3.8 CM 139.7 74.93 13.21 11.94 11.68 9.65 TIRE AND POSITION SOLO RIDING CAPACITIES Fuel Tank (including reserve) U.S. 5.4 gallons
2.1
LITERS 20.44 1.51 1.89 0.95
Reserve/Low Fuel indicator light at 0.4 gallons Oil Tank Transmission 2.0 quarts 1.0 quart
GVWR
24.5 degrees
Front-Dunlop Sportmax II Touring 32 PSI 36 PSI Radial 120/70 ZR 17 D205F (220 kPa) (248 kPa) WEIGHTS Wet Weight: - S3 - S3T GVWR (S3/S3T) GAWR - Front (S3/S3T) GAWR - Rear (S3/S3T) LBS. KG Rear-Dunlop Sportmax II Touring Radial 170/60 ZR 17 D205 36 PSI 38 PSI (248 kPa) (262 kPa)
11 1WARNING WARNING
Do not inate any tire beyond its maximum ination pressure as specied on tire sidewall. Overination may cause tire to suddenly deate which could result in death or serious injury.
NOTE Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) (maximum allowable loaded vehicle weight) and corresponding Gross Axle Weight Ratings (GAWR) are given on an information decal located on the left front down tube.
BRAKE SERVICE WEAR LIMITS Minimum Rotor Thickness (Front and Rear) Minimum Brake Pad Thickness (Front and Rear)
MM 4.5 1.0
2-1
HOME
TORQUE VALUES
ITEM Brake Bleeder Valve Clutch Cable, Primary Cover Fitting Clutch Clamp Screw Drive Support Nut Exhaust Header Nuts Footrest Bolts Footrest Mount Bolts Front Axle Nut Front Axle Pinch Screw Front Brake Caliper Half Screws Front Brake Line Clamp Screw Front Brake Master Cylinder Clamp Screw Front Brake Rotor Mounting Screws Front Caliper Banjo Bolt Front Caliper Bleeder Valve Front Caliper Pad Hanger Pin Front Caliper Mounting Bolt Front Fairing Mount Bolts Front Fender Lower Mounting Screws Front Fender Upper Mounting Screws Front Fork Damper Bolt Front Fork Triple Clamp Screw (Large) Front Fork Triple Clamp Screw (Small) Front Master Cylinder Banjo Bolt Front Master Cylinder Cover Screws Front Shock Mounting Bolt Fuel Tank Mounting Bolt
TORQUE 3-5 ft-lbs 3-5 ft-lbs 30-33 in-lbs 30-35 ft-lbs 6-8 ft-lbs 24-30 ft-lbs 10-15 ft-lbs 48-53 ft-lbs 13-15 ft-lbs 14.5-18 ft-lbs 30-35 in-lbs 80-90 in-lbs 20-22 ft-lbs 16-20 ft-lbs 3-5 ft-lbs 11-14.5 ft-lbs 22-25 ft-lbs 22-25 ft-lbs 10-15 in-lbs 20-25 in-lbs 18-23 ft-lbs 18-20 ft-lbs 12-15 ft-lbs 16-20 ft-lbs 9-13 in-lbs 40-45 ft-lbs 18-23 ft-lbs, then wait 5 minutes and retighten. 10-12 ft-lbs 4-7 Nm 4-7 Nm 3-4 Nm 41-47 Nm 8-11 Nm 33-41 Nm 14-20 Nm 65-72 Nm 18-20 Nm 20-24 Nm 3-4 Nm 9-10 Nm 27-30 Nm 22-27 Nm 4-7 Nm 15-20 Nm 30-34 Nm 30-34 Nm 1-2 Nm 2-3 Nm 24-31 Nm 24-27 Nm 16-20 Nm 22-27 Nm 1-2 Nm 54-61 Nm 24-31 Nm, then wait 5 minutes and retighten. 14-16 Nm metric Special procedure. metric LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE metric metric metric metric turn clockwise to install metric
NOTES
must be tight, but not binding LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 272 (red) LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 243 (blue), metric metric metric
HOME ITEM Header Support Mounting Bolt (Upper) Mirror Mounting Nuts Mufer Clamp Mufer Mounting Bolts (Front) Mufer Mounting Bolts (Rear) Mufer Support Mounting Bolt (Rear) Rear Axle Nut Rear Brake Caliper Banjo Bolt Rear Brake Caliper Bleeder Valve Rear Brake Caliper Mounting Screw (Large) Rear Brake Caliper Mounting Screw (Small) Rear Brake Lamp Switch Rear Brake Line Clamp Screw Rear Brake Reservoir Mounting Screw Rear Brake Rotor Screws Rear Master Cylinder Banjo Bolt Rear Master Cylinder Mounting Screws Rear Master Cylinder Rod to Brake Pedal Screw Rear Shock Mounting Screw Saddlebag Support Bracket Upper Bolt Sprocket Bolt Sprocket Cover Mounting Screw Sprocket Cover Screw Swingarm Pinch Screw Swingarm Threaded Rod Swingarm/Drive Support Screw Switchgear Housing Screws, (left side) Switchgear Housing Screws, (right side) Valve Stem Nut TORQUE 30-33 ft-lbs 7-10 in-lbs 40-45 ft-lbs 22-24 ft-lbs 22-24 ft-lbs 12-15 ft-lbs 66-73 ft-lbs 16-20 ft-lbs 3-5 ft-lbs 18-22 ft-lbs 14.5-18 ft-lbs 7-8 ft-lbs 10-12 ft-lbs 12-15 in-lbs 35-40 ft-lbs 16-20 ft-lbs 8-10 ft-lbs 10-12 ft-lbs 30-33 ft-lbs 13-17 ft-lbs 55-65 ft-lbs 12-17 in-lbs 4-6 ft-lbs 27-30 ft-lbs 11-12 ft-lbs 20-25 ft-lbs 25-33 in-lbs 12-17 in-lbs 42-44 in-lbs 41-45 Nm 0.8-1.1 Nm 54-61 Nm 30-33 Nm 30-33 Nm 16-20 Nm 90-99 Nm 22-27 Nm 4-7 Nm 24-30 Nm 20-24 Nm 10-11 Nm 14-16 Nm 1-2 Nm 48-54 Nm 22-27 Nm 11-14 Nm 14-16 Nm 41-45 Nm 18-23 Nm 75-88 Nm 1-2 Nm 5-9 Nm 37-41 Nm 15-16 Nm 27-34 Nm 3-4 Nm 1-2 Nm 4.7-5.0 Nm 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis 2-3 LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 272 (red) LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 243 (blue) LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 222 (purple) LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 243 (blue) LOCTITE THREADLOCKER torque only 222 (purple), initial metric LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 272 (red), metric metric metric metric metric metric LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 272 (red), metric LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 272 (red), metric LOCTITE PIPE SEALANT WITH TEFLON metric discard after use NOTES
HOME
TIRE SPECIFICATIONS
GENERAL 11 1WARNING WARNING
Tires must be correctly matched to wheel rims. Only the tires listed in the tment tables below can be used for replacement. Mismatching tires and rims can cause damage to the tire bead during mounting. Using tires other than those specied can adversely affect motorcycle handling and could result in death or serious injury.
2.2
Tire sizes are molded on the sidewall. Rim size and contour are marked on the rims exterior surface. Example: MT 3.5 x 17.0 DOT
G G G
MT designates the rim contour. 3.5 is the width of the bead seat measured in inches. 17.0 is the normal diameter of the rim in inches, measured at the bead seat diameter. DOT means that the rim meets Department of Transportation Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards.
2-4
HOME
2.3
b0304x2x
Manufacturer: Buell Motorcycle Company Type Designation: Engine Horsepower Code Model Year: 1 = 2001 Model Year Sequential Number 000001-020000 = World 020001-025000 = CA FS = S3T RS = S3 11 = World 56 = California
000001
Sample S3 V.I.N. as it appears on the steering head - 4MZ RS11 J1 1 3 000001 Sample abbreviated S3 V.I.N. as it appears on the left side crankcase - RS111000001 Sample S3T V.I.N. as it appears on the steering head - 4MZ FS11 J1 1 3 100001 Sample abbreviated S3T V.I.N. as it appears on the left side crankcase - FS111100001 Figure 2-2. 2001 Model Year Thunderbolt S3/S3T V.I.N.s
2-5
HOME
WHEELS
GENERAL
Good handling and maximum tire mileage are directly related to the care of wheels and tires. Regularly inspect wheels and tires for damage and wear. If handling problems occur, see 1.23 TROUBLESHOOTING or Table 2-3. See 1.7 TIRES AND WHEELS for tire pressures. Keep tires inated to the recommended air pressure. Always balance the wheel after replacing a tire.
b0195x2x
2.4
11 1WARNING WARNING
Do not inate any tire beyond its maximum ination pressure as specied on tire sidewall. Overination may cause tire to suddenly deate which could result in death or serious injury.
TROUBLESHOOTING
See Figure 2-3. Check tire ination pressure at least once each week. At the same time, inspect tire tread for punctures, cuts, breaks and other damage. Repeat the inspection before long trips.
Excessive side-play or radial (up-and-down) play in wheel hubs. Alignment of rear wheel in frame or with front wheel. Rims and tires out-of-true sideways; should not be more than 0.080 in. (2.03 mm). Rims and tires out-of-round or eccentric with hub; should not be more than 0.090 in. (2.29 mm). Irregular or peaked front tire wear. Correct tire ination. Correct tire and wheel balance. Steering head bearings. Damper tubes. Shock absorbers. Swingarm bearings.
Replace as described under 2.5 FRONT WHEEL, 2.6 REAR WHEEL and 2.8 TIRES. Inate tires to correct pressure. See 1.7 TIRES AND WHEELS. Static balance may be satisfactory if dynamic balancing facilities are not available. However, dynamic balancing is strongly recommended. Correct adjustment and replace pitted or worn bearings. See 1.15 STEERING HEAD BEARINGS. Check for leaks. See 2.16 FRONT FORK. Check damping action and mounts. See 1.13 SUSPENSION DAMPING ADJUSTMENTS. Check for looseness. See 2.19 SWINGARM.
2-6
HOME
11 1WARNING WARNING
Improper or improperly installed or repaired tires may adversely affect motorcycle traction, steering and handling which could result in death or serious injury. Always use the following guidelines when installing a new tire or repairing a at: 1. 2. Always locate and eliminate the cause of the original tire failure. Do not patch or vulcanize a tire casing. These procedures weaken the casing and increase the risk of a blowout. The use of tires other than those specied can adversely affect handling resulting in death or serious injury. Tires and wheels are critical items. Since the servicing of these components requires special tools and skills, Buell recommends that you see your dealer for these services.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Do not operate a vehicle with excessively worn tires. Excessively worn tires adversely affect motorcycle traction, steering and handling and could result in death or serious injury. At regular intervals of 5000 miles (8000 km) or whenever handling irregularities are noted, perform the recommended service checks. See Table 2-3. If tires must be replaced, same as original equipment tires must be used. Other tires may not t correctly and may be hazardous to use.
3.
4.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Buell recommends replacement of any tire punctured or damaged. In some cases small punctures in the tread area may be repaired from within the demounted tire by your Buell dealer. Speed should not exceed 50 mph (80 km/h) for the rst 24 hours after repair and the repaired tire should NEVER be used over 80 mph (130 km/h). In emergency situations, if a temporary repair is made, ride slowly with as light of a load as possible until the tire is permanently repaired or replaced. Failure to follow this warning could result in death or serious injury.
2-7
HOME
FRONT WHEEL
REMOVAL
b0331x2x
2.5
1.
Raise front wheel off oor using FRONT WHEEL SUPPORT STAND (2) (Part No. B-41395-A) and LIFT ADAPTER (1) (Part No. B-42577). Detach front brake caliper from rotor. See 2.11 FRONT BRAKE CALIPER. NOTE 1. 2. 3. 4.
4 1
Hole in Axle Pinch Screws (4) (metric) Washer Axle Nut (metric)
2.
Do not operate front brake lever with front wheel removed or caliper pistons may be forced out. Reseating pistons requires caliper disassembly. 3. 4. 5. 6. See Figure 2-4. Insert screwdriver/rod through hole in axle (1). Loosen front axle nut (4) (metric). Loosen all four pinch screws (2) (metric). Remove front axle nut (4) and washer (3). Pull front axle out of wheel hub while supporting front wheel. See Figure 2-5. Remove front wheel.
DISASSEMBLY
1. 2. See Figure 2-5. Move wheel to bench area. On brake rotor side of wheel, remove right axle spacer (10). Remove wheel bearings (4, 9) using BUSHING AND BEARING PULLER (Part No. HD-95760-69A) and 3/4 in. COLLET (Part No. HD-95767-69A). See Figure 2-5. Remove ve screws (12) to detach front brake rotor (15) from wheel hub. Remove tire. See 2.8 TIRES.
3. 4.
c.
d.
See Figure 2-5. Install spacer (8). Install new wheel bearings (4, 9) into hub using suitable driver. Press on outer race only. On the side of the wheel opposite the brake rotor insert left axle spacer (3) into hub until it seats in bore. Spacer sleeve must not be cocked or tilted in bore. On the right side of the wheel insert right axle spacer (10) into hub until it seats in bore. Spacer sleeve must not be cocked or tilted in bore. Install tire, if removed. See 2.8 TIRES. Verify that wheel and tire are true. See 2.7 CHECKING CAST RIM RUNOUT. Balance tire. See 2.8 TIRES, Adjustment.
1CAUTION
Never use compressed air to spin-dry bearings. Very high bearing speeds can damage unlubricated bearings. Spinning bearings with compressed air can also cause a bearing to y apart, which may result in minor or moderate injury. 2. 3. Inspect all parts for damage or excessive wear. Inspect brake rotor. a. Measure rotor thickness. Replace if less than service wear limit. See 1.6 BRAKE PADS AND ROTORS. Check rotor surface. Replace if warped or badly scored. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis
3.
4.
5.
6. 7.
b. 2-8
8.
HOME
Nut (metric) Washer Left Axle Spacer Wheel Bearing Wheel Valve Stem Wheel Weight Spacer Wheel Bearing Right Axle Spacer Front Axle T-40 TORX Screws (5) Front Brake Rotor
2 4 1 3
8 9 10 7 6
13
11
12
b0701a2x
INSTALLATION
1. Install front axle. a. b. c. d. e. 2. Apply LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT to axle. Position wheel between forks with brake rotor on gearcase side of motor. With pinch screws (metric) loose, insert threaded end of axle through right side fork. Push axle through fork and wheel hub until axle begins to emerge from left side of hub. Push axle through left fork leg.
3.
See Figure 2-8. Install axle nut. a. b. c. d. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 243 (blue) to axle threads. Install washer (3) and axle nut (4) (metric) over threaded end of axle. Insert screwdriver or steel rod through hole (1) in axle. While holding axle stationary, tighten axle nut (4) (metric) to 48-53 ft-lbs (65-72 Nm).
4. 5.
TIghten the four front axle pinch screws (2) (metric) to 13-15 ft-lbs (18-20 Nm). Install front brake caliper. See 2.11 FRONT BRAKE CALIPER.
Compress the front suspension to make sure it is free and not binding.
2-9
HOME
REAR WHEEL
REMOVAL
1. 2. 3. Raise rear wheel off oor using REAR WHEEL SUPPORT STAND (Part No. B-41174). Remove saddlebags (if equipped). See 2.37 SADDLEBAGS (S3T). Detach rear brake caliper from caliper mount. See 2.14 REAR BRAKE CALIPER.
6851
2.6
6 4 3 5
NOTE Do not operate rear brake pedal with rear wheel removed or caliper piston may be forced out. Reseating piston requires caliper disassembly. 4. 5. 6. 7. See Figure 2-10. Loosen rear axle nut (1). Loosen rear axle adjuster locknuts (6, 7) and nuts (5) on both sides. Push wheel as far forward as possible. Slip secondary drive belt from bottom of belt sprocket and remove. Remove rear axle nut (1) (metric), lockwasher (2), washer (3), and axle carrier (4). Pull axle and washer out from left side and remove wheel. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
1
Axle Nut (metric) Lockwasher Washer Axle Carrier Axle Adjuster Bolt Locknut Locknut
DISASSEMBLY
1. See Figure 2-11. Move wheel to bench area. On the brake rotor side of the wheel, remove bearing using BUSHING AND BEARING PULLER (Part No. HD95760-69A) and 1 1/8 in. COLLET (Part No. HD-9576969). Remove two bearings from sprocket side of wheel. Remove four screws (metric) to detach rear brake rotor from wheel hub. Remove ve bolts and washers to detach belt sprocket from wheel hub.
6974
2. 3. 4.
2 3 1 4
1. 2. 3. 4. Axle Rear Brake Caliper Mount Swingarm Washer
1CAUTION
Never use compressed air to spin-dry bearings. Very high bearing speeds can damage unlubricated bearings. Spinning bearings with compressed air can also cause a bearing to y apart, which may result in minor or moderate injury. 2. 3. Inspect all parts for damage or excessive wear. Inspect brake rotor. a. Measure rotor thickness. Replace if less than service wear limit. See 1.6 BRAKE PADS AND ROTORS. Check rotor surface. Replace if warped or badly scored. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis
b. 2-10
HOME 1. Install rear brake rotor on side of wheel hub with room for a single wheel bearing. Place rotor surface listing minimum thickness specication away from wheel hub. a. b. c. Verify that rear brake rotor is thoroughly clean. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 272 (red) to each of the four screws (1) (metric). Fasten rotor to wheel hub using screws. Tighten to 35-40 ft-lbs (48-54 Nm).
b0305x2x
NOTE P/M wheels use a nut (not shown) with each screw (1). 2. Install belt sprocket on side of wheel hub with room for two wheel bearings. Place sprocket machined surface away from wheel hub. a. b. c. 3. Check sprocket for unusual wear, broken teeth or a damaged ange. Replace if necessary. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 272 (red) to each of the ve sprocket bolts. Install belt sprocket using bolts and washers Tighten to 55-65 ft-lbs (75-88 Nm). On the belt sprocket side of the wheel, install two bearings. Insert bearings separately, pressing on outer race only. Fully seated bearings will touch shoulder for spacer sleeve. Insert spacer sleeve into wheel hub. On the brake rotor side of the wheel, insert bearing into wheel hub until it contacts end of spacer sleeve. Press on outer race only. Figure 2-11. Removing Wheel Bearing
b. c.
4. 5.
Verify that wheel is true. See 2.7 CHECKING CAST RIM RUNOUT. Install tire if removed. Under all circumstances, check that wheel and tire are true. See 2.8 TIRES.
INSTALLATION
1. Place wheel centrally in the swingarm with the brake rotor in the caliper. Slide wheel far enough forward to slip belt over sprocket and then slide wheel back. Install rear axle. a. b. c. d. 3. 4. 5. 6. Apply LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT to axle. Insert axle through washer, left side of swingarm, rear brake caliper mount and wheel assembly. Place spacer between wheel hub and right side of swingarm. Slide axle through spacer and swingarm. Install washer, lockwasher and axle nut (metric). Do not fully tighten rear axle nut at this time.
2.
Attach rear brake caliper to caliper mount. See 2.14 REAR BRAKE CALIPER. Check for proper belt tension and wheel alignment. See 1.9 DRIVE BELT DEFLECTION. Tighten rear axle nut (14) (metric) to 66-73 ft-lbs (9099 Nm). Install saddlebags (if equipped). See 2.37 SADDLEBAGS (S3T).
2-11
HOME
2.7
2. 3.
Gauge rod
2. 3.
MAXIMUM LATERAL RUNOUT 0.040 in. (1.02 mm) 0.020 in. (0.51 mm)
MAXIMUM RADIAL RUNOUT 0.030 in. (0.76 mm) 0.020 in. (0.51 mm)
Gauge rod
2-12
HOME
TIRES
GENERAL
Inspect tires for punctures, cuts, breaks and wear at least weekly.
b0198x2x
2.8
11 1WARNING WARNING
Always check both tire sidewalls for arrows indicating forward rotation. Some tires require different tire rotation depending on whether tire is used on front or rear wheel. Installing a tire with the wrong rotation could result in death or serious injury.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Dunlop front and rear tires for Buell motorcycles are not the same. They are not interchangeable. Use front tire ONLY for a front tire. DO NOT put a rear tire on the front of a vehicle. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. Some tires have arrows molded into the tire sidewall. These tires should be mounted on the rim with the arrow pointing in the direction of forward rotation. The red circle on the sidewall is a balance mark and should be located next to the valve stem hole. A bead breaker machine simplifies tire removal Figure 2-14. Loosening Beads from Rim Flange
b0199x2x
Pry bead over rim edge and remove tire from rim
REMOVAL
1. 2. 3. Remove wheel from motorcycle. See 2.5 FRONT WHEEL or 2.6 REAR WHEEL. Deate tire. See Figure 2-14. Loosen both tire beads from rim ange.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Do not use excessive force when starting bead over rim. Excessive force may damage tire or rim and adversely affect handling which could result in death or serious injury. 4. If a bead breaker machine is not available, attach RIM PROTECTORS (Part No. HD-01289) to the rim. Using tire tools (not sharp instruments), start upper bead over edge of rim at valve. Repeat all around rim until rst bead is over rim. See Figure 2-15. Push lower bead into rim well on one side and insert tire tool underneath bead from opposite side. Pry bead over rim edge. Remove tire from rim. Remove valve stem if it is damaged or leaks. Mount tire on TIRE SPREADER (Part No. HD-21000) for inspection and repair procedures.
b0200x2x
5.
6. 7.
2-13
HOME
b0087x2x
11 1WARNING WARNING
Aftermarket valve caps that are heavier than the stock cap may have clearance at slow speeds; but, at high speed the valve/cap will be moved outward by centrifugal force. This outward movement could cause the valve/cap to strike the adjacent components, damage the valve and cause rapid tire deation. Rapid tire deation could cause loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 1. Damaged or leaking valve stems must be replaced. Place rubber grommet on valve stem with shoulder in recess of the valve stem head. Install and tighten nut to 42-44 in-lbs (4.7-5.0 Nm). Thoroughly lubricate rim anges and both beads of tire with tire lubricant. See Figure 2-16. Starting at the valve stem, start rst bead into the rim well using a bead breaker machine. If no machine is available, work bead on as far as possible by hand. Use a tire tool to pry the remaining bead over rim ange. Start 180 from valve stem hole and place second bead on rim. Work bead onto rim with tire tools, working toward valve in both directions.
Gauge
2. 3. 4.
5.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Do not inate tire over 40 psi (275 kPa) to seat the beads. If the beads fail to seat to 40 psi (275 kPa), deate and relubricate the bead and rim and reinate to seat the beads, but do not exceed 40 psi (275 kPa). Inating the tire beyond 40 psi (275 kPa) to seat the beads can cause the tire rim assembly to burst with force sufcient to cause death or serious injury. 6. Apply air to stem to seat beads on rim. It may be necessary to use a TIRE BEAD EXPANDER (Part No. HD28700) on the tire until beads seal on rim.
2.
ADJUSTMENT
Wheel Balancing
Wheel balancing is recommended to improve handling and reduce vibration, especially at high road speeds.
3. 4.
2-14
HOME In most cases, static balancing using WHEEL TRUING AND BALANCING STAND (Part No. HD-99500-80) will produce satisfactory results. However, dynamic balancing, utilizing a wheel spinner, can be used to produce ner tolerances for better high-speed handling characteristics. Follow the instructions supplied with the balance machine you are using.
1.0 oz. (28 g) total weight applied to the front wheel. 2.0 oz. (56 g) total weight applied to the rear wheel.
Wheels should be balanced to within 1/4 oz. (7 g) at 60 MPH (97 KM/H). See Figure 2-19. Use only WHEEL WEIGHTS (Part No. 43692-94Y) which have special self-adhesive backings. Apply WHEEL WEIGHTS to the at surface of the wheel rim. 1. 2. Make sure that area of application is completely clean, dry and free of oil and grease. Remove paper backing from weight. For additional adhesive strength, apply three drops of LOCTITE SUPERBONDER 420 to adhesive side of weight. Place weight on at surface of wheel rim. Press weight rmly in place and hold for ten seconds. Allow eight hours for adhesive to cure completely before using wheel.
b0417x2x
3. 4. 5.
2-15
HOME
BRAKES
GENERAL
The front and rear brake systems use D.O.T. 4 BRAKE FLUID and D.O.T. 4 compatible banjo washers and rear brake lines.
G G
2.9
11 1WARNING WARNING
D.O.T. 4 brake uid can cause irritation of eyes and skin, and may be harmful if swallowed. If large amount of uid is swallowed, induce vomiting by administering two tablespoons of salt in a glass of warm water. Call a doctor. In case of contact with skin or eyes, ush with plenty of water. Get medical attention for eyes. KEEP BRAKE FLUID OUT OF THE REACH OF CHILDREN. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
D.O.T. 4 compatible banjo washers are black in color. D.O.T. 4 compatible rear brake lines have an olive drab coating on the metal portion of the line.
The front and rear brakes are fully hydraulic disc brake systems that require little maintenance. The front brake master cylinder is an integral part of the brake hand lever assembly. The rear brake master cylinder is located on the right side of the motorcycle near the brake pedal. Check the master cylinder reservoirs for proper uid levels after the rst 500 miles (800 km) and every 5000 miles (8000 km) thereafter. Also inspect uid levels at the end of every riding season. See 1.5 BRAKES. Check brake pads and rotors for wear at every service interval. See 1.5 BRAKES. Replace D.O.T. 4 BRAKE FLUID:
G
11 1WARNING WARNING
Never mix D.O.T. 4 with other brake uids (such as D.O.T. 5). Use only D.O.T. 4 brake uid in motorcycles that specify D.O.T. 4 uid on the reservoir cap. Mixing different types of uid may adversely affect braking ability and lead to brake failure which could result in death or serious injury.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Use only fresh, uncontaminated D.O.T. 4 uid. Cans of uid that have been opened may have been contaminated by moisture in the air or dirt. Use of contaminated brake uid may adversely affect braking ability and lead to brake failure which could result in death or serious injury.
Every 2 years.
It is recommended to inspect both front and rear brake lines and replace as required:
G
Every 4 years.
11 1WARNING WARNING
If rear brake line must be replaced, use only the brake line with the olive drab coating on the metal portion of the line (See Parts Catalog for Part No.) with DOT 4 brake systems. The previous black metal brake line is NOT compatible with DOT 4 brake uid. Failure to comply may adversely affect braking ability and lead to brake failure which could result in death or serious injury.
It is recommended to inspect both front and rear caliper and master cylinder seals and replace as required:
G
Every 2 years.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Clean brake system components using denatured alcohol. Do not use mineral-base cleaning solvents, such as gasoline or paint thinner. Use of mineral-base solvents causes deterioration of rubber parts that continues after assembly. This may result in improper brake operation which could result in death or serious injury.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Use only new black banjo washers (See Parts Catalog for Part No.) with D.O.T. 4 brake uid. Earlier silver banjo washers are not compatible with D.O.T. 4 uid and will not seal properly over time. Failure to comply may adversely affect braking ability and lead to brake failure which could result in death or serious injury.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Always test motorcycle brakes at low speed after servicing or bleeding system. To prevent death or serious injury, Buell recommends that all brake repairs be performed by a Buell dealer or other qualied technician. 2-16 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis
CAUTION Cover painted surfaces and right handlebar switches and use care when removing brake reservoir cover and adding D.O.T. 4 brake uid. Spilling D.O.T. 4 brake uid on painted surfaces will result in cosmetic damage. Spilling brake uid on switches may render them inoperative.
HOME
Brake fade
Cup in master cylinder not uncovering relief port. Rear brake pedal linkage out of adjustment.
Adjust linkage.
2-17
HOME
2.10
11 1WARNING WARNING
Any leak in the brake system will adversely affect brake operation. Damaged banjo bolt seating surfaces will leak when reassembled. Prevent damage to seating surfaces by carefully removing brake line components. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. 2. See Figure 2-21. Remove banjo bolt (6) (metric) and two banjo washers (4) to disconnect brake line (5) from master cylinder. Discard banjo washers. Remove screw (10), lockwasher (9) and washer (8) to detach brake lamp switch (7).
b0203a2x
3 2 4 5
3.
NOTE The individual parts of the brake lamp switch are not serviceable. Replace switch upon failure. 4. Remove two screws (1) (metric) and clamp (2) to detach master cylinder assembly from handlebar.
6 7 8 10 9
DISASSEMBLY
1. See Figure 2-22. Detach front brake hand lever. a. b. c. 2. Remove nut (1) (metric) from lever pivot. Remove pivot bolt (2) from lever pivot. Detach front brake hand lever (3) from master cylinder assembly. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Clamp Screws (2) (metric) Clamp Master Cylinder Cover Screws (2) Banjo Washers (2) Brake Line
6. 7.
See Figure 2-23. Remove screw, lockwasher and washer (1) holding front brake switch (2) to master cylinder assembly. Remove switch. See Figure 2-24. Compress piston (2) and remove boot (1). Depress piston assembly and remove internal snap ring (3). Discard snap ring. See Figure 2-25. Remove piston assembly (1-4) from front master cylinder. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis
Banjo Bolt (metric) Front Brake Lamp Switch 8. Washer 9. Lockwasher 10. Screw
3. 4. 5.
2-18
HOME
6488
11 1WARNING WARNING
Clean brake system components using denatured alcohol. Do not use mineral-base cleaning solvents, such as gasoline or paint thinner. Use of mineral-base solvents causes deterioration of rubber parts that continues after assembly. This may cause improper brake operation which could result in death or serious injury. 1. Clean all parts with denatured alcohol or D.O.T. 4 BRAKE FLUID. Do not contaminate with mineral oil or other solvents. Wipe dry with a clean, lint free cloth. Blow out drilled passages and bore with a clean air supply. Do not use a wire or similar instrument to clean drilled passages in bottom of reservoir. Carefully inspect all parts for wear or damage and replace as necessary. Inspect piston bore in master cylinder housing for scoring, pitting or corrosion. Replace housing if any of these conditions are found. See Figure 2-26. Inspect outlet port that mates with brake line tting. As a critical sealing surface, replace housing if any scratches, dents or other damage is noted. Inspect boot for cuts, tears or general deterioration. Replace as necessary.
1
1. 2. 3. Nut (metric) Pivot Bolt Hand Lever Figure 2-22. Hand Lever
2.
6489
3.
2
4.
5.
3
1. 2. 3. Screw, Lockwasher and Washer Front Brake Switch Tang
ASSEMBLY
1. See Figure 2-26. Check piston assembly components. a. b. Small end of spring (1) sits behind primary cup (2). Large side of primary cup faces spring. Secondary cup (3) sits within ridge at middle of piston (4).
6490
1 2
2. 3. 4.
Insert piston assembly, spring rst, into master cylinder. Secure with a new snap ring (6). Install ridge on boot (5) into groove on piston (4). See Figure 2-22. Install front brake hand lever. a. b. Align hole in lever (3) with hole in master cylinder assembly. Lubricate pivot bolt (2) with LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE. Install pivot bolt through top of assembly. Tighten to 4-13 in-lbs (1-2 Nm). Install nut (1) (metric). Tighten to 44-62 in-lbs (5-7 Nm).
3
1. 2. 3. Boot Piston Snap Ring Figure 2-24. Snap Ring 5.
c. d.
See Figure 2-27. Install front brake switch. a. b. Attach front brake switch with screw, washer and lockwasher (1). Tighten to 7-13 in-lbs (1-2 Nm). Test switch action. Tang (2) on switch must release when hand lever (3) is moved.
2-19
HOME
6491
INSTALLATION
1 2 3 4 5
1. See Figure 2-21. Fasten master cylinder to handlebar by installing clamp (2) and screws (1) (metric). Tighten to 80-90 in-lbs (9-10 Nm).
6
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Spring Primary Cup Secondary Cup Piston Boot Snap Ring Figure 2-25. Piston Assembly
11 1WARNING WARNING
Use only new black banjo washers (See Parts Catalog for Part No.) with D.O.T. 4 brake uid. Earlier silver banjo washers are not compatible with D.O.T. 4 uid and will not seal properly over time. Failure to comply may adversely affect braking ability and lead to brake failure which could result in death or serious injury.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Any leak in brake system will adversely affect brake operation. To avoid leakage after assembly, verify that gaskets, banjo bolt, hydraulic brake line and bore of master cylinder are completely clean. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
6492
Outlet Port
2.
Connect brake line (5) to master cylinder using two new banjo washers (4) and banjo bolt (6) (metric). Tighten to 16-20 ft-lbs (22-27 Nm). Attach brake lamp switch (7) with screw (10), lockwasher (9) and washer (8). Remove two master cylinder cover screws (3), cover and cover gasket. See Figure 2-28. With the master cylinder in a level position, add D.O.T. 4 BRAKE FLUID. Bring uid level to within 1/8 in. (3.2 mm) of molded boss inside front master cylinder reservoir.
6493
11 1WARNING WARNING
1
Always verify proper operation of relief port (see Step 6). A plugged or covered relief port can cause brake drag or lockup, which may cause loss of vehicle control which could result in death or serious injury. 6. Verify proper operation of the master cylinder relief port. Actuate the brake lever with the reservoir cover removed. A slight spurt of uid will break the surface if all internal components are working properly. Attach master cylinder cover, cover gasket and plastic insert with two cover screws. Tighten to 9-13 in-lbs (1-2 Nm). Bleed brake system. See 1.5 BRAKES.
3
7.
8. 1. 2. 3. Screw, Lockwasher and Washer Tang Hand Lever Figure 2-27. Testing Hand Lever
11 1WARNING WARNING
Check for proper brake lamp operation before riding motorcycle (see Step 9). Visibility is a major concern for motorcyclists. Failure to have proper brake lamp operation could result in death or serious injury. 9. Turn ignition key switch to IGN. Apply brake hand lever to test brake lamp operation. Turn ignition key switch to OFF.
2-20
HOME
2.11
1 2 3 5
11 1WARNING WARNING
Any leak in brake system will adversely affect brake operation. Damaged banjo bolt seating surfaces will leak when reassembled. Prevent damage to seating surfaces by carefully removing brake line components. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. 2. See Figure 2-28. Remove banjo bolt (2) (metric) and two gaskets (3) to disconnect brake line (1) from caliper. Discard gaskets. Remove brake pads. a. b. Remove pin plug (4). See Figure 2-29. Remove pad hanger pin (1) (metric). Remove pad spring (2). Remove brake pads from caliper.
6544
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Brake Line Banjo Bolt (metric) Banjo Washers (2 - typical)) Pin Plug Mounting Screws (2) Figure 2-28. Front Brake Caliper Mounts (Typical)
3.
c. d. 4.
See Figure 2-28. Detach caliper from mounts. a. Remove both mounting screws (5) while supporting caliper above brake rotor. Slowly remove caliper by tilting away from wheel and then pulling away from rotor.
2 1
b.
DISASSEMBLY
1. See Figure 2-29. Remove four screws (3) (metric) to separate caliper halves. Remove two O-rings from between caliper halves and discard. See Figure 2-30. Use BRAKE CALIPER PISTON REMOVER (Part No. B-42887) without adaptor to pull the six pistons from caliper bores. See Figure 2-31. Pry O-rings (6) out of their respective grooves on each side of caliper. Discard O-rings. Check bleeder valve (4) (metric). Remove and replace if damaged. 1. 2. 3. Pad Hanger Pin (metric) Pad Spring Screws (4) (metric)
2.
4.
5.
2-21
HOME
6495
2.
6482
4 2 1 6 7 5 3
3.
b.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Failure to install brake pads as a set may adversely affect brake operation. Always replace brake pads in complete sets for correct brake operation. Never replace just one brake pad. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. 4. Inspect brake pads for damage or excessive wear. Replace both pads as a set if the friction material of either pad is worn to 0.04 in. (1.0 mm) or less.
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
Outside Caliper Half Inside Caliper Half O-Ring (2) Bleeder Valve (metric) Piston (3 sizes, 2 each) Piston O-Rings (3 sizes, 2 each) Screws (4) (metric) Figure 2-31. Caliper O-rings and Pistons
ASSEMBLY INSTALLATION
1. See Figure 2-31. Install pistons and O-rings. 1. a. Apply a light coat of D.O.T. 4 BRAKE FLUID to Orings, pistons and caliper piston bores. Install two new O-rings (6) in grooves of each piston bore. Install pistons (5) in each piston bore. 2. Fit front brake caliper on rotor. a. b. Check rotor attachment to carrier. Inspect all six brake drive pins for missing hardware. Make sure rotor is centered on carrier. Use two clamps on rotor and carrier to reduce freeplay and center rotor. Slide caliper over front brake rotor without brake pads installed.
b.
c. 2. 3.
c.
Install two new O-rings (3) between caliper halves. Attach caliper halves together with four screws (7) (metric). Tighten to 14.5-18 ft-lbs (20-24 Nm). Install a new bleeder valve (4) (metric) if necessary. Tighten to 3-5 ft-lbs (4-7 Nm).
See Figure 2-28. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 272 (red) to both caliper mounting screws (5). Install and tighten to 22-25 ft-lbs (30-34 Nm). Install brake pads. a. b. See Figure 2-32. Insert brake pads from behind. See Figure 2-29. Install pad spring (2) with opening at top as shown.
4.
3.
2-22
HOME c. d. Install pad hanger pin (1) (metric). Tighten to 1114.5 ft-lbs (15-20 Nm). See Figure 2-28. Install pin plug (4). Tighten to 1.52.1 ft-lbs (2-3 Nm). 10. Turn ignition key switch to IGN. Apply brake hand lever to test brake lamp operation. Turn ignition key switch to LOCK. NOTE Avoid making hard stops for the rst 100 miles (160 km) to allow new brake pads to wear in properly with the brake rotor.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Use only new black banjo washers (See Parts Catalog for Part No.) with D.O.T. 4 brake uid. Earlier silver banjo washers are not compatible with D.O.T. 4 uid and will not seal properly over time. Failure to comply may adversely affect braking ability and lead to brake failure which could result in death or serious injury.
6545
11 1WARNING WARNING
Any leak in brake system will adversely affect brake operation. To avoid leakage, verify that gaskets, banjo bolt, hydraulic brake line and caliper bore are completely clean. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. 4. Connect brake line (1) to caliper using two new banjo washers (3) and banjo bolt (2) (metric). Tighten to 16-20 ft-lbs (22-27 Nm). CAUTION Cover painted surfaces and right handlebar switches and use care when removing brake reservoir cover and adding D.O.T. 4 brake uid. Spilling D.O.T. 4 brake uid on painted surfaces will result in cosmetic damage. Spilling brake uid on switches may render them inoperative. 5. See Figure 2-33. Remove both master cylinder cover screws (2). Remove master cylinder cover (1) and gasket. With the master cylinder in a level position, verify that the brake uid level is 1/8 in. (3.2 mm) from molded boss inside reservoir. Add D.O.T. 4 BRAKE FLUID if necessary.
6069a
1 2
6.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Always verify proper operation of relief port (see Step 7). A plugged or covered relief port can cause brake drag or lockup, which may cause loss of vehicle control which could result in death or serious injury. 7. Verify proper operation of the master cylinder relief port. Actuate the brake lever with the reservoir cover removed. A slight spurt of uid will break the surface if all internal components are working properly. Install master cylinder cover and cover gasket with two screws (1). Tighten to 9-13 in-lbs (1-2 Nm). Depress front brake lever several times to set brake pads to proper operating position within caliper. Bleed brake system. See 1.5 BRAKES. 1. 2. Master Cylinder Cover Screws (2) Figure 2-33. Master Cylinder Cover
8. 9.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Check for proper brake lamp operation before riding motorcycle (see Step 10). Visibility is a major concern for motorcyclists. Failure to have proper brake lamp operation could result in death or serious injury. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis 2-23
HOME
2.12
Tighten master cylinder banjo bolt (metric) to 16-20 ft-lbs (22-27 Nm). Tighten brake caliper banjo bolt to 16-20 ft-lbs (22-27 Nm). CAUTION Cover painted surfaces and right handlebar switches and use care when removing brake reservoir cover and adding D.O.T. 4 brake uid. Spilling D.O.T. 4 brake uid on painted surfaces will result in cosmetic damage. Spilling brake uid on switches may render them inoperative. 7. 8. Install bleeder valve if removed. Rell master cylinder and bleed brakes. See 1.5 BRAKES Turn ignition key switch to IGN. Apply brake hand lever to test brake lamp operation. Turn ignition key switch to OFF.
b0364x2x
11 1WARNING WARNING
Any leak in brake system will adversely affect brake operation. Damaged banjo bolt seating surfaces will leak when reassembled. Prevent damage to seating surfaces by carefully removing brake line components. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. 3. Remove master cylinder banjo bolt (metric) and two banjo washers to disconnect brake line from master cylinder. Discard banjo washers. Remove caliper banjo bolt and two banjo washers to disconnect brake line from caliper. Discard banjo washers. Carefully inspect the brake line for dents, cuts or other defects. Replace the brake line if any damage is noted.
Brake Line
4. 5.
Banjo Bolt
3. 4.
2-24
HOME
2.13
11 1WARNING WARNING
Any leak in brake system will adversely affect brake operation. Damaged banjo bolt seating surfaces will leak when reassembled. Prevent damage to seating surfaces by carefully removing brake line components. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. 2. See Figure 2-36. Remove banjo bolt (1) (metric) and two banjo washers (2) to detach brake line (3) from master cylinder (4). Discard banjo washers. See Figure 2-37. Disconnect push rod from brake pedal turn buckle (4). a. b. 4. 5. Spin locknut (3) away from top surface of turn buckle. Turn rod adjuster (2) to free rod from turn buckle (4).
b0474x2x
1 2 4 3
13 5
3.
See Figure 2-38. Remove two screws (2) (metric) to detach master cylinder (3) from frame. See Figure 2-39. Detach remote reservoir. a. b. Remove top or bottom clamp on hose connected to master cylinder. Remove screw to detach reservoir from frame if necessary.
7 8 9 10 11
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. Banjo Bolt (metric) Banjo Washers (2) Brake Line Master Cylinder Screw (2) (metric) Piston Assembly Push Rod Snap Ring Rubber Boot Locknut Turnbuckle Screw Remote Reservoir Figure 2-36. Rear Master Cylinder Assembly
12
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE Do not disassemble master cylinder unless problems are experienced. Discard all seals during the disassembly procedure. Install a complete rebuild kit upon assembly. 1. 2. 3. See Figure 2-40. Slide rubber boot on rod assembly (3) away from master cylinder body (1). Depress rod assembly (3) and remove internal snap ring (2). Discard snap ring. Remove piston assembly (4) from master cylinder body.
2-25
HOME
b0470x1x
1 2 3
4
1. 2. 3. 4. Rubber Boot Rod Adjuster Locknut Top Surface of Turn Buckle Figure 2-37. Brake Push Rod
Inspect boot on front of master cylinder for cuts, tears or general deterioration. Replace if necessary.
ASSEMBLY
1. 2. See Figure 2-40. Insert piston assembly (4), spring rst, into master cylinder. Place round side of rod assembly (3) over piston. Depress piston into master cylinder body (1) and secure with a new snap ring (2). Tuck rubber boot on rod assembly (3) into master cylinder body (1).
6546
1 2
3.
INSTALLATION
1. See Figure 2-39. Connect remote reservoir. a. b. 2. If removed, attach remote reservoir to frame using screw. Tighten to 12-15 in-lbs (1-2 Nm). Attach line to master cylinder using clamp. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
See Figure 2-38. Attach master cylinder (3) to frame using two screws (2) (metric). Tighten to 8-10 ft-lbs (1114 Nm).
Banjo Bolt (metric) Screw (2) (metric) Master Cylinder Body Clamp Remote Reservoir Hose Figure 2-38. Master Cylinder Mounting
11 1WARNING WARNING
Use only new black banjo washers (See Parts Catalog for Part No.) with D.O.T. 4 brake uid. Earlier silver banjo washers are not compatible with D.O.T. 4 uid and will not seal properly over time. Failure to comply may adversely affect braking ability and lead to brake failure which could result in death or serious injury.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Any leak in brake system will adversely affect brake operation. To avoid leakage after assembly, verify that gaskets, banjo bolt, hydraulic brake line and bore of master cylinder are completely clean. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. 3. See Figure 2-36. Connect brake line (3) to master cylinder (4) with two new banjo washers (2) and banjo bolt (1) (metric). Tighten to 16-20 ft-lbs (22-27 Nm).
2-26
HOME 4. See Figure 2-37. Install push rod. a. b. Screw push rod into turn buckle. Seat brake pedal height adjustment. See 1.5 BRAKES.
6543
11 1WARNING WARNING
Always verify proper operation of relief port (see Step 7). A plugged or covered relief port can cause brake drag or lockup, which may cause loss of vehicle control which could result in death or serious injury. 5. Verify proper operation of the master cylinder relief port. Actuate the brake lever with the reservoir cover removed. A slight spurt of uid will break the surface if all internal components are working properly. Add brake uid and bleed brake system. See 1.5 BRAKES. Figure 2-39. With motorcycle in a level position, check that brake uid is between the upper and lower marks on reservoir. Add D.O.T. 4 BRAKE FLUID if necessary. Be sure gasket and cap on reservoir t securely. Figure 2-39. Remote Reservoir
6. 7.
4688a
1 2
11 1WARNING WARNING
Check for proper brake lamp operation before riding motorcycle (see Step 8). Visibility is a major concern for motorcyclists. Failure to have proper brake lamp operation could result in death or serious injury. 8. Turn ignition key switch to IGN. Apply rear brake pedal to test brake lamp operation. Turn ignition key switch to LOCK. 1. 2. 3. 4. Master Cylinder Body Snap Ring Rod Assembly Piston Assembly Figure 2-40. Master Cylinder Internals
2-27
HOME
2.14
4 3 2
11 1WARNING WARNING
Any leak in brake system will adversely affect brake operation. Damaged banjo bolt seating surfaces will leak when reassembled. Prevent damage to seating surfaces by carefully removing brake line components. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. 2. See Figure 2-41. Remove banjo bolt (2) (metric) and two banjo washers (3) to disconnect brake line (1) from caliper. Discard banjo washers. Remove small screw (6) (metric) and large screw (7) (metric) to detach caliper from mount. See Figure 2-42. Remove clip (1) from rear caliper mount (2) if necessary.
7
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Brake Line Banjo Bolt (metric) Banjo Washers (2 - typical) Bleeder Valve (metric) Pin Plug and Pad Hanger (metric) Small Screw (metric) Large Screw (metric) Figure 2-41. Rear Brake Caliper (Typical)
3. 4.
DISASSEMBLY
1. 2. 3. See Figure 2-41. Remove pin plug and pad hanger (5) (metric) to free brake pads. See Figure 2-43. Remove clip (1) from caliper body. See Figure 2-44. Remove piston (3) using BRAKE CALIPER PISTON REMOVER (1) (Part No. B-42877) with adaptor (2). Remove two O-rings from groove in caliper bore. Discard O-rings.
6486
2 1
4.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Failure to install brake pads as a set may adversely affect brake operation. Always replace brake pads in complete sets for correct brake operation. Never replace just one brake pad. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
2.
2-28
HOME 4. Inspect brake pads for damage or excessive wear. Replace both pads as a set if the friction material of either pad is worn to 0.04 in. (1.0 mm) or less.
6487
2 1
ASSEMBLY
1. See Figure 2-43. Place clip (1) inside caliper body as shown.
NOTE To ensure proper brake pad-to-brake rotor clearance when the caliper is installed, piston must be pressed all the way into the bore whenever new brake pads are used. 2. See Figure 2-44. Install pistons and O-rings. a. b. c. 3. Apply a light coat of D.O.T. 4 BRAKE FLUID to Orings, piston and caliper piston bore. Place two new O-rings inside grooves of piston bore. Install piston (3) inside caliper body. 1. 2. 3. Brake Caliper Piston Remover Adaptor Piston
See Figure 2-43. Install brake pads (3) using pad hanger and pin plug (1). a. b. Install pad hanger pin (metric). Tighten to 11-14.5 ftlbs (15-20 Nm). Install pin plug. Tighten to 1.5-2.1 ft-lbs (2-3 Nm).
6487
4.
Install a new bleeder valve (metric) if necessary. Tighten to 3-5 ft-lbs (4-7 Nm).
INSTALLATION
1. 2. See Figure 2-42. Install caliper mount clip (1) if removed. See Figure 2-41. Install caliper assembly on caliper mount. Brake pad surfaces must face rear brake rotor. a. b. c. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 272 (red) to both caliper mounting screws (6, 7) (metric). Install large caliper screw (7) (metric). Tighten to 1822 ft-lbs (24-30 Nm) Install small caliper screw (6) (metric). Tighten to 14.5-18 ft-lbs (20-24 Nm). 4. 1. 2. 3.
2
Clip Pin Plug and Pad Hanger (metric) Brake Pads (2) Figure 2-43. Brake Pads
11 1WARNING WARNING
Use only new black banjo washers (See Parts Catalog for Part No.) with D.O.T. 4 brake uid. Earlier silver banjo washers are not compatible with D.O.T. 4 uid and will not seal properly over time. Failure to comply may adversely affect braking ability and lead to brake failure which could result in death or serious injury. 5.
Depress rear brake pedal several times to set brake pads to proper operating position within caliper. Bleed brake system. See 1.5 BRAKES. Verify proper uid level in reservoir.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Check for proper brake lamp operation before riding motorcycle (see Step 6). Visibility is a major concern for motorcyclists. Failure to have proper brake lamp operation could result in death or serious injury. 6. Turn ignition key switch to IGN. Apply brake pedal to test brake lamp operation. Turn ignition key switch to LOCK. NOTE Avoid making hard stops for the rst 100 miles (160 km) to allow new brake pads to wear in properly with the brake rotor. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis 2-29
11 1WARNING WARNING
Any leak in brake system will adversely affect brake operation. To avoid leakage, verify that gaskets, banjo bolt, hydraulic brake line and caliper bore are completely clean. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. 3. Connect brake line (1) to caliper using two new banjo washers (3) and banjo bolt (2) (metric). Tighten to 16-20 ft-lbs (22-27 Nm).
HOME
2.15
2 4
11 1WARNING WARNING
Any leak in brake system will adversely affect brake operation. Damaged banjo bolt seating surfaces will leak when reassembled. Prevent damage to seating surfaces by carefully removing brake line components. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. 2. See Figure 2-45. Remove banjo bolt (2) (metric) and two banjo washers (3) to disconnect brake line (1) from rear brake caliper. Discard banjo washers. Remove banjo bolt and two banjo washers to disconnect brake line from rear master cylinder. Discard banjo washers. Remove screw and clamp to detach brake line clamp from frame. See Figure 2-47. Remove bolt, washer, wireform and brake line from under oil tank. Remove wires from terminals (2,3) at top of brake lamp switch (4). Unthread brake lamp switch from tee nut.
6483a
3.
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Clamp Double Wire Terminal Single Wire Terminal Rear Brake Lamp Switch Wire Guide Figure 2-45. Rear Brake Line and Switch
4. 5. 6.
4 3 2
INSTALLATION
1
11 1WARNING WARNING
If rear brake line must be replaced, use only the brake line with the olive drab coating on the metal portion of the line (See Parts Catalog for Part No.) with DOT 4 brake systems. The previous black metal brake line is NOT compatible with DOT 4 brake uid. Failure to comply may adversely affect braking ability and lead to brake failure which could result in death or serious injury. 1. 2. See Figure 2-48. Install wireform to rear brake line as shown in gure. From left side of vehicle, feed new brake line from rear brake caliper mount forward to frame mount. Route brake line to the right towards rear master cylinder. See Figure 2-45. Install screw and clamp (1) to fasten rear brake line to frame tube. Tighten to 10-12 ft-lbs (1416 Nm). Place brake line inside wire guide (5) closest to master cylinder. See Figure 2-47. Attach the wireform under the oil tank with bolt and washer. 1. 2. 3. 4. Brake Line Banjo Bolt (metric) Banjo Washers (2 - typical) Bleeder Valve (metric)
3.
4. 5.
2-30
HOME
11 1WARNING WARNING
Use only new black banjo washers (See Parts Catalog for Part No.) with D.O.T. 4 brake uid. Earlier silver banjo washers are not compatible with D.O.T. 4 uid and will not seal properly over time. Failure to comply may adversely affect braking ability and lead to brake failure which could result in death or serious injury.
b0808x2x
Wireform
11 1WARNING WARNING
Any leak in brake system will adversely affect brake operation. To avoid leakage, verify that banjo washers, banjo bolt, hydraulic brake line and caliper bore are completely clean. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. 6. Connect brake line to master cylinder with two new banjo washers and banjo bolt (metric). Tighten to 1620 ft-lbs (22-27 Nm). See Figure 2-46. Connect brake line (1) to caliper with two new banjo washers (2) and banjo bolt (1) (metric). Tighten to 16-20 ft-lbs (22-27 Nm). See Figure 2-45. Install brake lamp switch (4). a. Coat brake lamp switch threads with LOCTITE PIPE SEALANT WITH TEFLON and install to tee nut of brake line. Tighten to 7-8 ft-lbs (10-11 Nm). b. Install wires on terminals (2, 3). Install bleeder valve if removed. Rell master cylinder and bleed brakes. See 1.5 BRAKES. Brake Line
7.
8.
b0809x2x
9.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Check for proper brake lamp operation before riding motorcycle (see Step 10). Visibility is a major concern for motorcyclists. Failure to have proper brake lamp operation could result in death or serious injury. 10. Turn ignition key switch to IGN. Apply rear brake pedal to test brake lamp operation. Turn ignition key switch to LOCK.
Step 1
Wireform
Step 2
Step 3
2-31
HOME
FRONT FORK
GENERAL
The front forks consists of two telescoping outer tube/inner slider assemblies. Each assembly has an internal compression spring which supports the forward weight of the vehicle and rider. The compression spring extends and retracts to cushion the ride over rough or irregular road surfaces. An oil lled damping mechanism controls the telescoping action of each tube/slider assembly. See 1.13 SUSPENSION DAMPING ADJUSTMENTS for more information. 9.
2.16
Remove the guide bushing (9), seal spacer (10), oil seal (11) stopper ring (12), and the dust seal (13) from the slide pipe (17).
6987
REMOVAL
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Raise front wheel off oor using procedure under 1.15 STEERING HEAD BEARINGS. Detach front brake caliper from rotor. See 2.11 FRONT BRAKE CALIPER. Remove front wheel. See 2.5 FRONT WHEEL. Remove front fender. See 2.31 FRONT FENDER. Loosen left and right headlamp brackets. Loosen the four large pinch screws on both the upper and lower triple clamps. Remove front forks through bottom of triple clamps. 1. 2. 3. Fork Bolt (metric) O-Ring Front Fork Holding Tool (Part No. B-41177) Figure 2-49. Fork Bolt
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE To prevent change in set position of damping force adjuster needle, do not loosen the lock nut. 1. See Figure 2-49. Loosen the fork bolt (1) (metric) from the outer tube and slightly compress the fork leg. Remove the fork bolt with attached O-ring (2). See Figure 2-50. Set the FRONT FORK SPRING COMPRESSOR (Part No. B-43875) (1) onto the spring collar (2). Push down on the collar and remove the spring seat stopper (3). See Figure 2-51. Remove the spring collar (4), the spring joint (5) and the spring (6). Remove the fork oil by pumping the fork leg and rod 8-10 times until the rod moves freely. Clamp the axle holder in a vise with soft jaws or use a shop towel. Remove the center bolt (19) (metric) and the special washer (18). Remove the damper (14) and the centering plate (15) from the slide pipe (17). 1. 2. 3. Fork Spring Compressor Spring Collar Spring Seat Stopper Figure 2-50. Front Fork Spring Compressor
6957
2.
3. 4. 5.
6.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Be careful not to scratch the slide pipe or the outer tube. Improperly operating forks may lead to a loss of control and death or serious injury. 7. 8. Remove the dust seal (13) and the stopper ring (12) from the outer tube (8). Pull the slide pipe (17) out of the outer tube (8). 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis
2-32
HOME
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20.
Fork Bolt O-Ring Spring Seat Stopper Spring Collar Spring Joint O-Ring Spring Outer Tube Guide Bushing Seal Spacer Oil Seal Stopper Ring Dust Seal Damper Assembly Centering Plate Slide Bushing Slide Pipe Special Washer Center Bolt Mounting Bolt
1 2 6 3 4 7 5
16
14 8
17 9 10 15 20 11 12 13 18 19
b0652x2x
Figure 2-51. Front Fork Assembly 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis 2-33
HOME
1 3 5 6 2 4
3.
4. 5. 6.
ASSEMBLY
2. 3.
4. 5.
9.
10. Clamp the axle holder in a vise with soft jaws or use a shop towel. Replace the special washer (18) and center bolt (19) (metric). Tighten the center bolt to 22-29 ft-lbs (30-39 Nm). NOTE The recommended fork oil is hydraulic fork oil Type E. 11. While supporting the fork, pour one-half of the recommended amount of fork oil, 8 oz. (225 cc), into the fork pipe. 12. Pump the piston rod and leg slowly at least 10 times, about 6 in. (150 mm) strokes. 2-34 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis Figure 2-54. Slide Pipe Protection
HOME 13. Place the centering plate (15) onto the damper (14) and insert the assembly into the slide pipe (17).
6958
14. Place the piston rod and outer tube (8) in the full bottomed position. 15. See Figure 2-56. Pour the recommended fork oil into the slide pipe to a level between the maximum and minimum limits. Additional information on setting oil levels can be found under 1.14 FRONT FORK. 16. See Figure 2-57. Install the spring, with the taper side at top, and the spring collar and spring joint. 17. See Figure 2-50. Place FRONT FORK SPRING COMPRESSOR (1) into position and press down on the spring collar (2). 18. Set the spring seat stopper (3) between the spring collar (2) and the locknut. Remove the FRONT FORK SPRING COMPRESSOR. 19. See Figure 2-49. Apply oil to a new O-ring and install it into position on the fork bolt. Install fork bolt. Tighten to 22-29 ft-lbs (30-39 Nm). 20. Tighten rebound adjuster against the fork bolt. 21. Set rebound and compression adjusters to factory positions. See 1.13 SUSPENSION DAMPING ADJUSTMENTS. 1. 2. 3.
2 3 1
Fork Seal Driver Guide Bushing with Seal Spacer Outer Tube Figure 2-55. Fork Seal Driver
b0666x2x
Oil Level: Maximum: )2.36 in. (60.0 mm) Minimum: 4.33 in. (110.0 mm
7097
2-35
HOME
INSTALLATION
1. Insert fork tubes through triple clamps. NOTE When installing the front forks, use a screwdriver to pry apart the triple clamps. 2. See Figure 2-58. Spread LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE on the last three threads of all ve triple clamp pinch screws. Loosely install triple clamp fasteners. If removed, small screw (1) installs at rear of upper triple clamp. Align and secure fork tubes. a. Position fork tubes so that top of each slider tube is ush with the top surface of upper triple clamp and cap protrudes slightly. Be sure that top surface of fork is not below top surface of upper triple clamp. Tighten large screws to 18-20 ft-lbs (24-27 Nm). Tighten small screw to 10-12 ft-lbs (14-16 Nm) if loosened during fork stem service.
8306
3.
b. c. 4. 5. 6. 7.
Install front fender. See 2.31 FRONT FENDER. Install front wheel. See 2.5 FRONT WHEEL. Install front brake caliper. See 2.11 FRONT BRAKE CALIPER. Adjust front forks to rider preferences. See 1.14 FRONT FORK. 1. 2. Small Upper Triple Clamp Screw Large Upper Triple Clamp Screw (2) Figure 2-58. Front Fork
2-36
HOME
2.17
1 11 2
3 4 5 5 4 3 10 6 8
12
c.
d. 6.
If replacement of bearing cups (5) is necessary, drive cups from steering head using STEERING HEAD BEARING RACE REMOVER (Part No. HD-39301A) and UNIVERSAL DRIVER HANDLE (Part No HD-33416).
9 7
Fork Stem Bolt Upper Triple Clamp Dust Shield (2) Roller Bearing (2) Bearing Cup (2) Lower Triple Clamp Lower Clamp Pinch Screws (2) Steering Head Lock Steering Lock Key Set Screw Small Pinch Screw Upper Clamp Pinch Screws (2) Figure 2-59. Fork Stem 6. 7. Install fork assemblies. See 2.16 FRONT FORK. Check adjustment. a. b. Install fork stem bolt (1). Check bearing adjustment to tighten fork stem bolt to proper tension. See 1.15 STEERING HEAD BEARINGS. Make sure the fork stem turns freely, then tighten the fork stem clamp screw (11).
2.
3.
ASSEMBLY/INSTALLATION
1. See Figure 2-59. If removed, install new bearing cups (5) into frame steering head using STEERING HEAD BEARING RACE INSTALLER (Part No. HD-39302). Liberally coat the bearing cones (4) with grease using WHEEL BEARING PACKER TOOL (Part No. HD-33067). Work the grease into the rollers. Install lower bearing. a. b. Place lower bearing dust shield (3) over fork stem. Find a section of pipe having an inside diameter slightly larger than the outside diameter of the fork stem. Press bearing (4) with small end up onto fork stem and lower triple clamp (6). Use the pipe as a presson tool.
2.
3.
c. 8.
c.
4.
Insert lower triple clamp (6) through the steering head. Install the upper bearing (4) with small end down and dust shield (3) onto fork stem. Apply LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE to fork stem bolt (1). Loosely install upper triple clamp (2) using fork stem bolt. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis 2-37
5.
HOME
2.18
1 3
2.
3. 4. 5. 6.
Loosen the three upper triple clamp screws. Slowly loosen fork stem bolt (4) until forks drop 0.5 in. (12.7 mm) in triple clamps. See Figure 2-61. Remove set screw behind lock. Extract steering head lock from fork stem. a. b. c. d. Insert fork key in lock. Lift front wheel upward. Twist key to pull steering head lock from fork stem. Release front wheel.
b0442x2x
NOTE Steering head lock is not repairable. Replace the unit if it fails.
INSTALLATION
1. Install steering head lock in fork stem. a. b. c. See Figure 2-62. Dished area of steering head lock faces front wheel. Lift front wheel upward. See Figure 2-61. Lock must be in the unlocked position to install. Insert lock with key openings positioned as shown. Release front wheel.
6310
d. 2.
See Figure 2-60. Tighten fork stem bolt and triple clamp screws. Check bearing adjustment. See 2.17 FORK STEM AND BRACKET ASSEMBLY. Install and adjust handlebars. See 1.19 HANDLEBARS.
3.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Operating a vehicle with steering head locked will restrict the vehicles turning ability and may result in an accident. Always make sure the steering head is not locked before operating vehicle. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. 4. Install set screw in lock. Test lock. a. b. c. d. e. 2-38 Turn handlebars all the way to the left. Insert ignition key in lock. Turn key clockwise while pushing in. Remove key and verify that steering head is locked. Unlock steering head by inserting key and turning 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis
Dished Area
HOME
SWINGARM
REMOVAL
NOTE Mark all hardware as it is removed so that it may be returned to its original location. 1. 2. Compress suspension to access rear fender fasteners. Remove rear fender and lower belt guard. Place vehicle on a lift and anchor front wheel in place.
6851
2.19
4 3
7 2 5 1
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Axle Nut (metric) Lockwasher Washer Axle Carrier Axle Adjuster Bolt Locknut Adjusting Nut Figure 2-63. Rear Axle, Right Side
11 1WARNING WARNING
To protect against shock and accidental start-up of vehicle, disconnect the negative battery cable before proceeding. Inadequate safety precautions could result in death or serious injury.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Always disconnect the negative battery cable rst. If the positive battery cable should contact ground with the negative cable installed, the resulting sparks may cause a battery explosion which could result in death or serious injury. 3. 4. Disconnect both battery cables, negative cable rst. Remove seat and attach lifting straps to motorcycle. a. 5. Insert lifting straps under frame tubes. It is not necessary to remove tail section.
Attach lifting straps to a oor hoist placed behind the lift. Raise motorcycle off lift until rear suspension is unloaded. Remove mounting bolt attaching swingarm to rear shock. See Figure 2-63. Remove rear wheel. a. b. Remove rear axle nut (1) (metric), lockwasher (2), washer (3) and right side axle carrier (4). Hold axle adjuster bolt (5) with a 5/16 in. wrench. Loosen locknut (6) and axle adjuster screws (7). Repeat on left side. From left side, slowly pull rear axle from swingarm. As axle is removed, remove right side spacer, rear brake caliper mount, left side axle carrier and washer. Suspend rear brake caliper mount from frame with a piece of rope. Push rear wheel forward and slip off belt. 1. 2. 3. 4.
6. 7.
c.
Drain Hose Clamp Drain Plug Frame Tube Figure 2-64. Oil Tank Drain, Typical
b0451xox
5. 6. 7.
See Figure 2-65. Place a jack under the crankcase. Detach rear tie bar from swingarm. See Figure 2-66. Remove left and right isolator bolts and washers (7). CAUTION
8.
Remove cap from oil tank. See Figure 2-64. Drain oil tank by removing clamp (2) from drain hose (1). Pull hose from drain plug (3). Detach feed line from bottom of oil tank.
9.
10. Detach rear brake pedal from master cylinder pushrod. 11. Remove left side rider footrest and shifter lever.
Do not attempt to raise frame with oil lter installed. Remove oil lter before raising frame. Failure to comply may result in damage to oil lter. 8. Place a drip pan under the oil lter. Remove oil lter. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis 2-39
HOME 9. Using oor hoist, raise frame enough to remove both rubber isolators (6) from frame mounted pins.
b0632xsb
10. Loosen swingarm pinch screw (4) on right side. 11. Remove threaded rod (1) from between bearing adjusting bolts (2, 3). 12. Loosen remaining swingarm pinch screw. 13. See Figure 2-67. Using oor hoist, raise frame while pushing down on swingarm. Frame must be raised until bearing adjustment bolts (2) clear pin on frame and can be removed. NOTE If swingarm mount block doesnt drop from frame as lift is raised, apply leverage between frame and mount block using a plastic hammer wrapped in clean shop towels. 14. After removing both bearing adjustment bolts, remove swingarm. Threads
2 1 5 4
7 6
INSTALLATION
1. 2. 3. 4. See Figure 2-66. Align new swingarm between posts on swingarm mount block (5). Insert left (threaded) and right bearing adjustment bolts (2, 3) into swingarm until ush with mount block surface. Tighten left side swingarm pinch screw (4) to 18-20 ft-lbs (24-27 Nm). Install threaded rod (1). a. b. c. 5. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 222 (purple) to threaded rod. Insert threaded rod through right side bearing adjustment bolt (2) into threads on left side bolt (3). Tighten rod to an initial torque of 11-12 ft-lbs (15-16 Nm). 7. 6. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Threaded Rod Bearing Adjustment Bolt (Right) Bearing Adjustment Bolt (Left, Threaded) Pinch Screw (2) Swingarm Mount Block Rear Isolator TORX Bolt and Washer (2) Rear Isolator (2) (Typical) Figure 2-66. Swingarm Assembly See Figure 2-66. Secure swingarm in place. a. b. c. d. Remove both pinch screws (1). Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 243 (blue) to threads of pinch screws. Verify that swingarm is centered between mounts. Install both pinch screws. Tighten to 18-20 ft-lbs (2427 Nm).
Check swingarm preload using a scale as shown in Figure 2-68. Preload should be 3.0-3.75 lbs (1.36-1.70 kg). If preload does not meet specications, tighten or loosen threaded rod and recheck.
Insert REAR ISOLATOR REPLACEMENT TOOL (Part No. B-44623) between mount block and frame. NOTE: Ledge on tool should engage top of mount block. Position rear isolators in mounting position. Slowly lower frame to place rubber isolators in front of bearing adjustment bolts. Install isolator bolts. See 2.20 REAR ISOLATORS for complete procedure. a. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 271 (red) to threads of both isolator bolts. Apply LOCTITE ANTISEIZE to underside of TORX bolt head. Install isolator TORX bolts and washers (7) through rubber isolators and into bearing adjustment bolts (2, 3). Tighten isolator TORX bolts to 63-70 ft-lbs (85-95 Nm).
8.
6875
9.
b.
c.
10. Attach rear tie bar to swingarm mount block. Tighten to 30-33 ft-lbs (41-45 Nm). 11. Remove scissors jack from under crankcase. Figure 2-65. Scissors Jack 2-40 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis 12. Install rear shock bolt (metric). Tighten to 30-33 ft-lbs (41-45 Nm).
HOME 13. Attach feed and drain lines to oil tank and frame. Install lter and ll motorcycle with proper oil. a. Use 2.0 quarts (1.89 liters). 14. Attach rear brake pedal to master cylinder pushrod. 15. Attach left side rider footrest and shifter lever. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 272 (red) to bolt. Tighten to 23-25 ft-lbs (31-34 Nm). 16. Install rear wheel. a. b. Wipe any grease or dust from rear axle. Apply LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT to axle. See Figure 2-69. Insert axle (1) through washer (2) so that rounded side of washer will face swingarm. Continue through left side of swingarm, rear brake caliper mount (3) and wheel assembly. See Figure 2-63. Place spacer between wheel hub and right side of swingarm. Slide axle through spacer and swingarm. Place washer (3) on axle with rounded side facing swingarm. Install lockwasher (2) and axle nut (1) (metric). Do not fully tighten rear axle nut at this time. 1. 2. 3.
6888
1 3 2
Rear Axle Washer Rear Brake Caliper Mount Figure 2-69. Rear Axle, Left Side 17. Set axle alignment and belt deection. See 1.9 DRIVE BELT DEFLECTION. a. See Figure 2-70. Check rear axle alignment. See Figure 2-71. Check belt deection. Proceed to the next step when both axle alignment and belt deection are correct. b. c.
c.
d.
6874
18. See Figure 2-72. Tighten locknut (2) ush against adjusting nut (3). Tighten axle nut (metric) to 66-73 ft-lbs (9099 Nm). Verify that belt deection is correct. Lower motorcycle onto lift.
2
1. 2. 3. Pinch Screw Bearing Adjustment Bolt Pin on Frame for Rear Isolator Figure 2-67. Swingarm Mount Block, Right Side
11 1WARNING WARNING
After installing seat, pull upward on front of seat to be sure it is locked in position. If seat is loose, it could shift during vehicle operation and startle the rider, causing loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 19. Remove lifting straps and install seat. See 2.35 SEAT.
11 1WARNING WARNING
6876
Always connect positive battery cable rst. If the positive cable should contact ground with the negative cable installed, the resulting sparks may cause a battery explosion which could result in death or serious injury. 20. Attach both battery cables, positive cable rst.
21. Remove motorcycle from lift. 22. Compress suspension to install rear fender and lower belt guard. 23. Check oil level after starting motorcycle and allowing it to reach operating temperature.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Figure 2-68. Checking Preload After completing repairs or bleeding the system, always test motorcycle brakes at low speed. If brakes are not operating properly or braking efciency is poor, testing at high speeds could result in death or serious injury. 24. Check rear brake operation. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis 2-41
HOME
6816
b0633xsb
1. 2. 3.
Axle Adjuster Bolt Locknut Adjusting Nut Figure 2-72. Axle Adjuster Bolt, Right Side Shown
2-42
HOME
REAR ISOLATORS
MODEL YEAR CHANGE
b0204x2a
2.20
Screws (2) Blue Loctite Spacer
All 2001 Air Twin Buell Models have new isolators with snubbers to reduce isolator shear. The sprocket cover has been modied from previous years to allow clearance for the snubber.
Sprocket Cover
Screw 48-72 in-lbs (5-9 Nm) Blue Loctite Screws (2) 20-25 ft-lbs (27-34 Nm) Red Loctite Swingarm/Drive Support
11 1WARNING WARNING
Always disconnect the negative battery cable rst. If the positive battery cable should contact ground with the negative cable installed, the resulting sparks may cause a battery explosion which could result in death or serious injury. 1. 2. 3. Disconnect both battery cables from battery, negative cable rst. Remove seat and fuel tank. See 2.35 SEAT and 4.36 FUEL TANK. Remove the left side rider footpeg mounting bolt and footpeg. Allow footpeg and shift linkage to hang being careful not to scratch primary cover. See Figure 2-73. On the right side of the motorcycle, remove the front sprocket cover assembly. See Figure 2-73. Remove two screws that attach sprocket cover to the backside of the swingarm/drive support. Retain screws. Discard sprocket cover.
4. 5.
NOTE See Figure 2-74. Route strap under frame rails with tail section installed. Make sure strap is in V formed by frame rails to prevent rearward movement and that it does not pinch wiring harness, vent lines or cables. 6. See Figure 2-74. Strap tail section of frame to overhead beam or hoist and put slight tension on strap to secure frame assembly. See Figure 2-75. Remove frame side tie bar mounting hardware from front lower and center tie bars. Leave fourth tie bar (front upper) attached to both frame and engine. See Figure 2-75. Remove rear tie bar bolt, lockwasher and washers from mount block. Discard lockwasher. See Figure 2-75. Loosen left side isolator bolt from swing arm bearing adjusting bolt. Do not remove.
7.
8. 9.
10. See Figure 2-75. Remove right side isolator bolt and washer from swingarm bearing adjustment bolt. Discard isolator bolt, but retain washer. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis 2-43
HOME 17. Pull frame to left and remove left side isolator from 6:00 or 7:00 position. Discard isolator.
8263
Strap
INSPECTION
NOTE If roll pin protrudes beyond specication, check to make sure it is fully seated. A channel lock pliers may be used to squeeze/push roll pin in. Protect frame with a shop rag when using pliers.
Frame Rails
See Figure 2-77. Measure isolator roll pin protrusion on both left and right isolator mounts with calipers or metal rule. Roll pin should not protrude more than 0.120 in. (3 mm). If roll pin protrudes more than 0.120 in. (3 mm) le or grind until within specication; 0.080-0.120 in. (2.032-3.048 mm). Use care when ling to avoid creating sharp edges. Top View
INSTALLATION
8262
Bottom View
1.
On left side of motorcycle, align locator hole with roll pin and install new left rear isolator provided in kit. The left isolator backing plate has an L stamped on it. Move to right side of motorcycle. Lower the frame approximately two inches with the hoist to allow clearance between isolator replacement tool and the new larger isolator. See Figure 2-76. On right side of motorcycle, insert rear isolator replacement tool between mount block and frame. CAUTION
2.
Strap
Figure 2-74. Floor Hoist 11. See Figure 2-76. Working on the right side rst, insert the REAR ISOLATOR REPLACEMENT TOOL (Part No. B-44623) between mount block and frame. NOTE: Ledge on tool should engage top of mount block. CAUTION Do not alter tool or shim in an attempt to spread frame further than tool will allow. Failure to comply may result in frame distortion or damage. 12. Turn nut on rear isolator replacement tool clockwise to expand frame from swingarm mount block until isolator can be removed. Nut will stop when limit of travel is reached. 13. Disengage right side rear isolator from roll pin in frame by pulling inboard. Remove isolator by pulling out from 5:00 or 6:00 position. Discard rear isolator. 14. Remove rear isolator replacement tool by turning nut counterclockwise. 15. Remove left side isolator bolt and washer from bearing adjusting bolt. Discard isolator bolt, but retain washer. 16. Remove nut and back out bolt (until ush with the mount block) from upper rear of mufer Z bracket and swingarm mount block. 2-44 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis
Do not alter tool or shim in an attempt to spread frame further than tool will allow. Failure to comply may result in frame distortion or damage. 4. Turn nut on tool clockwise to expand frame from mount block. Nut will stop when limit of travel is reached.
b0202c3x
Lockwasher
HOME 10. See Figure 2-75. Install new isolator TORX bolts and washers through both rubber isolators into bearing adjustment bolts on each side. Ledge CAUTION Rear Isolator See Figure 2-78. Observe marked line on both rubber isolators after isolator bolts are tightened. If line twists, apply more LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE to underside of isolator bolt heads. Failure to comply will result in damage to rubber isolators. 11. Tighten right and left isolator bolts to 63-70 ft-lbs (85-95 Nm). Frame Mount Block
b0869x2x
12. Push rear upper Z bracket bolt until it protrudes from mount block and install nut. Tighten rear upper Z-bracket bolt to 22-24 ft-lbs (30-33 Nm). 13. Erase grease pencil marked lines from both isolators. 14. Install front lower and center tie bars to frame with original locknuts. Tighten bolts to 30-33 ft-lbs (41-45 Nm). Install rear tie bar to mount block with new lockwasher. Tighten bolt to 30-33 ft-lbs. (41-45 Nm). 15. Remove hoist from tail section. 16. Install left side rider footpeg. Tighten bolt to 25-30 ft-lbs (34-41 Nm). 17. See Figure 2-73. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 243 (Blue) to threads of two sprocket cover to swingarm/drive support screws and install new sprocket cover to swingarm/drive support. 18. See Figure 2-73. Install new sprocket cover assembly with original hardware. a. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 243 (blue) to screw. Install sprocket cover assembly with screw, washer and spacer. Tighten to 48-72 in-lbs (5-9 Nm). Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 272 (red) to swingarm/drive support mounting screws and install. Tighten screws to 20-25 ft-lbs (27-34 Nm). Install locknut and washer. Tighten to 30-35 ft-lbs (41-47 Nm).
Pin
b.
c. Figure 2-77. Measuring Roll Pin Protrusion 5. On right side of motorcycle, align locator hole with roll pin and install new right rear isolator provided in kit. The right isolator backing plate has an R stamped on it. Turn nut on tool counterclockwise to allow frame to return to position. Remove tool from between frame and mount block. Raise frame with hoist to align isolator bolt holes with threaded holes in bearing adjusting bolts. Mark a horizontal line across the front of each isolator with a light colored grease pencil or by other non-permanent means. Apply anti-seize to underside of new isolator bolt heads. CAUTION Use caution when installing isolator bolts. Make sure isolator bolt hole is aligned with threaded hole in bearing adjusting bolt to avoid cross-threading bolt.
b0674b2x
Rear Isolator
6.
Marked Line
7. 8.
9.
HOME
11 1WARNING WARNING
After installing seat, pull upward on front of seat to be sure it is locked in position. If seat is loose, it could shift during vehicle operation and startle the rider, causing loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 19. Install fuel tank and seat. See 2.35 SEAT and 4.36 FUEL TANK.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Always connect the positive battery cable rst. If the positive cable should contact ground with the negative cable installed, the resulting sparks may cause a battery explosion, which could result in death or serious injury. 20. Connect battery cables, positive cable rst, to battery terminals. 21. Test ride motorcycle at low speed and check for proper operation.
2-46
HOME
2.21
All 2001 Air Twin Buell Motorcycles have a new rear shock absorber and a new front shock mount. The new 2001 front shock mount must be used with the new rear shock to t properly. The new shock absorber has a remote reservoir that allows for rebound damping adjustment.
GENERAL
See Figure 2-80. The rear suspension is controlled by the shock absorber. The shock allows adjustment of rear compression and rebound damping and spring preload. The most important rear shock adjustment is the preload setting. Before making any damping adjustments, set the proper preload. See 1.12 PRELOAD ADJUSTMENT. NOTE The rear shock absorber contains no user serviceable parts. 2. 3. Allen Screw 30-33 ft-lbs (41-45 Nm) Allen Screw 40-45 ft-lbs (54-61 Nm)
INSTALLATION
1. See Figure 2-80. Place new bushings into mounting holes of shock absorber (if only replacing bushings). See Figure 2-79. Loosely install rear allen screw (metric) and new locknut. Loosely install front allen screw (metric) and new locknut. Install rear clamp over front oil pump tting. Slide reservoir through rear clamp. Position front clamp over reservoir and loosely install front reservoir clamp to front shock mount with washer and nylon locknut. Install reservoir mount block between oil pump tting and remote reservoir. Tighten clamps around reservoir. NOTE Tighten front hardware from the screw side only. Tighten rear hardware from the nut side only. 9. Tighten front allen screw to 40-45 ft-lbs (54-61 Nm).
REMOVAL
4. 1. Lift rear wheel off ground using REAR WHEEL SUPPORT STAND (Part No. B-41174). Remove seat and attach lifting straps to motorcycle. Insert lifting straps under frame tubes. It is not necessary to remove tail section. Attach lifting straps to a oor hoist placed behind the motorcycle. Raise motorcycle off lift until rear suspension is unloaded. Use a ex socket and extension to remove locknut and washer from front reservoir clamp. Discard clamp and locknut. Loosen rear reservoir clamp. Slide reservoir and mount block out of clamp. Remove and discard clamp. See Figure 2-79. Remove allen screw (metric) and locknut on front mount. Discard locknut. While supporting the shock absorber, remove the allen screw (metric) and locknut from the rear mount. Discard locknut. Remove shock absorber assembly. Inspect and replace bushings as required. 5. 6.
2.
7. 8.
3.
4.
11 1WARNING WARNING
After installing seat, pull upward on front of seat to be sure it is locked in position. If seat is loose, it could shift during vehicle operation and startle the rider, causing loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 11. Remove lifting straps and install seat. See 2.35 SEAT. 12. Check rear shock preload. See 1.12 PRELOAD ADJUSTMENT.
6.
7.
8. 9.
2-47
HOME
b0918x2x
2-48
HOME
SUSPENSION THEORY
DEFINITIONS
G
b0854x2x
2.22
Damping: Resistance to movement. Damping affects how easily the suspension can move and limits oscillation of the system once movement has begun. Compression: Suspension is compressed when the wheel moves upward. Rebound: The suspension is rebounding when it is moving back from being compressed. Vehicle Sag: The amount the rear shock and fork springs are compressed by the weight of the motorcycle. Rider Sag: The amount the rear shock and fork springs are compressed by the weight of the rider. Preload: An adjustment made to the rear shock and fork springs (if applicable) to limit vehicle and rider sag to a standard percentage of total suspension travel. Proper preload adjustment allows the suspension to absorb most bumps without bottoming. Rebound Adjuster Slotted Dial Figure 2-81. Rear Shock Rebound Damping Adjustment
b00851x2x
Locknut Preload Adjuster Figure 2-82. Preload and Compression Damping Adjustment
b0559xox
Rebound Adjuster
b0558xox
Compression Adjuster
Figure 2-83. Front Fork Adjusters 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis 2-49
HOME
SUSPENSION ADJUSTMENTS
SPRING PRELOAD
Adjust rear spring preload before attempting any other adjustments. See 1.12 PRELOAD ADJUSTMENT. This setting assures that the rear suspension has the proper amount of travel for the riders weight and the motorcycles cargo load. Make this adjustment before the motorcycle is ridden any distance. Your Buell dealer can assist you if necessary.
2.23
Recommended Rear Shock Damping Settings (S3/S3T)
SETTINGS
Front Rebound Front Compression Rear Rebound Rear Compression
SOLO (STD)
0.5 1.75 1 2.5
2 UP
1 1.25 0.5 0.25
SOLO (FIRM)
0.5 1.25 0.5 1
SOLO (SOFT)
1.5 MIN 2.5 MIN
ADJUSTMENTS
Evaluating and changing the rebound and compression damping is a very subjective process. A good performing suspension nds a proper balance between spring, spring preload, damping, track conditions and riding speed. However, all settings are at best a compromise. If a rider fails to nd a good set-up, go back to the factory recommended settings and start over again. Make all suspension adjustments in one or two click increments. Adjusting more than one or two clicks at a time may cause you to skip the best adjustment. Test ride after each adjustment. When an adjustment makes no difference, return to the previous adjustment and try a different approach. To nd the optimum settings you will need the preload properly adjusted, the tires properly inated and a familiar bumpy road. It is useful if the road contains a variety of different bumps from small sharp bumps such as potholes or frost heaves to large undulations. Begin the process by putting all the damping adjustments at the factory recommended settings. Ride the bike over a variety of different surfaces and bumps at different speeds. When the suspension is set properly the motorcycle will be stable and comfortable.
See Figure 2-83. Adjust compression damping using the slotted dial on the bottom of each fork leg.
G
11 1WARNING WARNING
Always adjust each fork leg to the same settings. Uneven adjustment between left and right forks may lead to a loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 1. Using a screwdriver, turn the slotted dial on the appropriate adjuster clockwise until it stops. This is the maximum damping setting for that adjustment. Then turn the dial counterclockwise the recommended amount to align the reference marks. This is the factory recommended setting.
2.
See Figure 2-82. Adjust compression damping using the slotted dial on the shaft at the end of the shock.
G
2.
2-50
HOME an uncomfortable feeling are suspension problems. Handling and a swinging fork are geometry-related, but often these unwanted characteristics can be solved by suspension adjustments.
2.
Decrease the compression damping. If the problem persists, decrease rebound damping for a faster rebound rate. Less spring preload may also help. The suspension is too soft. Increase compression damping. The suspension is too hard. Decrease compression damping.
Lack of tire feedback. Sliding during cornering. Sliding may occur going into the corner or accelerating out of the corner.
2-51
HOME
2-52
HOME
THROTTLE CONTROL
REMOVAL/DISASSEMBLY
1. See Figure 2-85. Slide rubber boot (5) off the cable adjusters (4). Loosen cable adjuster lock (3) on each adjuster. See Figure 2-86. Remove two screws (1, 6) on front housing. Separate housings from handlebar. Unhook ferrules (7) from cable wheel (8). Remove cables from notches in housings (5, 9). Remove air cleaner cover and backplate. See 4.41 AIR CLEANER. NOTE: On S3T models, this includes removing the right fairing lower. See Figure 2-84. Remove screw and throttle cable clamps from cables by throttle body. Disconnect cables from throttle body manifold to remove. Figure 2-84. Throttle Cable Clamps Screw Arrow (Up) Throttle Cable Clamps
2.24
2. 3. 4. 5.
6. 7.
ASSEMBLY/INSTALLATION
1. See Figure 2-86. Place cable assemblies (3, 4) into housings (5, 9). Throttle control cable (4) has a molded tting end and is positioned inside the front housing (5). Idle control cable (3) has a smaller tting end and is positioned inside the rear housing (9). Run cables inside grooves of each housing (5, 9). Attach ferrules (7) to cable wheel (8). When properly assembled, notches for ferrules will be at 12 oclock. Position housings on right handlebar by engaging locating pin (10) on front housing with hole in handlebar. Attach housings with two screws (1, 6), installing longer screw on bottom. Tighten to 12-17 in-lbs (1-2 Nm). Adjust throttle cables. See 1.20 THROTTLE CABLES. See Figure 2-84. Attach throttle cable clamp to ferrules with screw (arrow on clamp points up). Install air cleaner assembly. See 4.41 AIR CLEANER. On S3T models, also install the right fairing lower.
2. 3. 4.
5. 6. 7.
2-53
HOME
6853
3 4 1 5 2
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Throttle Control Cable Idle Control Cable Cable Adjuster Lock Cable Adjuster Rubber Boot Figure 2-85. Throttle Control Cables
7098
6 8 7 4 9
10
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10.
Screw (short, top) Cable Adjusters (2) Idle Control Cable Throttle Control Cable with Molded End Front Housing Screw (long, bottom) Ferrules Cable Wheel Rear Housing Locating Pin Figure 2-86. Cable Connections
2-54
HOME
CLUTCH CONTROL
REMOVAL/DISASSEMBLY
NOTE For information on clutch adjustment, see 1.8 CLUTCH.
2.25
Clutch Hand Control
1. See Figure 2-88. Detach clutch switch (7). a. b. c. Remove screw (8). Depress clutch lever and hold. Detach switch by depressing switch trigger button and pulling switch towards the end of the handlebar.
Clutch Cable-Lower
1. 2. Raise rear wheel off oor using REAR WHEEL SUPPORT STAND (Part No. B-41174). See Figure 2-87. Remove four TORX screws (1) with washers and clutch inspection cover (2). Do not damage or dislodge quad ring (14) in primary cover (11). Slide spring (3) with attached hex lockplate (4) from ats of adjusting screw (12). Turn adjusting screw clockwise to release ramp and coupling mechanism. As the adjusting screw is turned, ramp assembly moves forward. Unscrew nut (5) from end of adjusting screw. Remove hook of ramp (6) from button at the rear of cable end coupling (16). Remove cable end (10) from slot in coupling. Turn cable end tting (9) counterclockwise to remove clutch cable lower section from primary cover (11). Remove O-ring (8) from cable end tting.
NOTE The individual parts of the clutch switch are not serviceable. Replace switch upon failure. 2. 3. 4. 5. Remove bolt (2) (metric) and nut (6) (metric). Remove handlever from clutch clamp (5). Detach clutch cable from handlever. Remove clutch cable clamp (10) from frame. Remove clutch clamp. a. b. c. Cut off left handgrip. Remove left handlebar switch housing. See 7.16 HANDLEBAR SWITCHES. Remove clamp screw (4) (metric). Slide clamp off the end of the handlebar.
3. 4.
5.
6.
TORX Screw with Washer (4) Clutch Inspection Cover Spring Adjusting Screw Lockplate Nut Outer Ramp Ball (3) O-Ring Cable End Fitting Clutch Cable End Primary Cover Clutch Adjusting Screw Assembly Retaining Ring Quad Ring Inner Ramp Coupling 2
b0131a6x
11 12
10
9 8 6 3 4 5 13 15 16 14 7
2-55
HOME
ASSEMBLY/INSTALLATION
Clutch Cable-Lower
1. See Figure 2-87. Install O-ring (8) over cable end tting (9) of clutch cable lower section. Turn tting clockwise to install into primary cover (11). Tighten to 3-5 ft-lbs (4-7 Nm). Fit coupling (16) over cable end. Place hook of ramp around coupling button and rotate assembly counterclockwise until tang on inner ramp (15) ts in slot of primary cover (11). Thread nut (5) on adjusting screw (12) until slot of screw is accessible with a screwdriver. Fit nut hex into recess of outer ramp (6) and turn adjusting screw counter-clockwise. If not yet performed, route clutch cable to hand control. a. See Figure 2-89. Route cable along left side of primary chaincase and up through clamp on front isolator tie bar. Continue above and behind lower triple clamp, between left fork leg and steering neck. Route cable across front of upper triple clamp to hand grip.
b0406x2x
3 4 2 1
7) h( c t i sw
5 9 7 8
2.
ve mo e R
3.
4.
10
b. c. 5.
With clutch cable upper section connected to clutch lever, check primary chain tension. Adjust if necessary. See 1.11 PRIMARY CHAIN. Adjust clutch. See 1.8 CLUTCH.
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
6. 7. 8. 9. 10.
6.
8307
Clamp
Clutch
d. 2. 3.
Connect end of clutch cable upper section to clutch handlever. Position lever within clutch clamp. Apply small amount of LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT to bolt (2). Attach handlever with bolt (2) (metric) and nut (6) (metric). Attach clutch switch (7) with screw (8). If not yet performed, route clutch cable to primary cover. a. b. c. Route cable from hand grip across front of upper triple clamp. Continue to left side, down between left fork leg and steering neck, above lower triple clamp. See Figure 2-89. Route cable down left side of bike, through clamp, along primary chaincase to clutch. Figure 2-89. Clutch Cable Routing, Lower
4. 5.
6.
With clutch cable lower section connected to primary cover, adjust clutch. See 1.8 CLUTCH.
2-56
HOME
HANDLEBARS
REMOVAL
1. 2. Remove front brake master cylinder. See 2.10 FRONT BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER. Remove left handlebar switch housing. See 7.16 HANDLEBAR SWITCHES. Cut left handlebar grip and remove. Detach clutch hand control from handlebars. See 2.25 CLUTCH CONTROL. Loosen screws on right handlebar switch housing, but do not detach throttle grip assembly from handlebar. See 2.24 THROTTLE CONTROL. See Figure 2-90. Remove four screws (1, 2) from handlebar clamp (3). Slide handlebars out of throttle grip assembly to remove. 1. 2. 3. Front Clamp Screws (2) Rear Clamp Screws (2) Handlebar Clamp Figure 2-90. Handlebar Clamp
6286
2.26
1 3
3. 4.
5. 6.
INSTALLATION
6287
1.
Slide handlebars into throttle grip assembly. Fasten right handlebar switch housing to handlebar. See 2.26 HANDLEBARS. Install clutch hand control. See 2.25 CLUTCH CONTROL. See Figure 2-91. Install handlebar clamp. a. b. c. d. Route right hand control wires (1) under handlebar and in front of fork tube (4) and handlebar clamp (3). Route left hand control wires (2) under handlebar and in front of fork tube (4) and handlebar clamp (3). See Figure 2-90. Tighten both front screws (1) to 1012 ft-lbs (14-16 Nm). Then tighten both rear screws (2) 10-12 ft-lbs (14-16 Nm). 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
4 3 1 5 2 6
2. 3.
4. 5.
Install left switch housing. See 7.16 HANDLEBAR SWITCHES Install a new left handgrip. a. b. c. d. Clean end of handlebar with M600. Place LOCTITE 411 ADHESIVE around inside of grip. Push grip onto handlebar end. Twist grip on bar until end touches left switchgear housing. Wipe off excess adhesive with a rag.
Right Hand Control Cables Left Hand Control Cables Handlebar Clamp on Upper Triple Clamp Fork Tube Front Brake Line Throttle Cables Figure 2-91. Routing Hand Control Wires
6. 7.
Install front brake master cylinder. See 2.10 FRONT BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER. Check steering motion range to both fork stops. See 1.15 STEERING HEAD BEARINGS.
2-57
HOME
EXHAUST SYSTEM
MODEL YEAR CHANGE
All 2001 S3/S3T Models have new front and rear exhaust mounts.
6751
2.27
REMOVAL/DISASSEMBLY
Muffler
Mufer
NOTE The mufer may be removed for replacement without removing the exhaust header. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. On S3T models, remove right side fairing lower. See 2.38 FAIRING LOWERS (S3T). See Figure 2-92. Remove bolts, lockwashers and washers securing mufer to Z-bracket. See Figure 2-93. Remove bolts and locknuts with washers from header support mount. Loosen screw securing mufer clamp. Remove mufer and mufer clamp. Discard clamp. If necessary, remove mufer support Z-bracket. a. b. c. 7. Remove bolts, locknuts and washers. Remove mufer support Z-bracket. Remove rear mufer mounts and mount spacers from swingarm mount block. Metal Locknut Washer
Washers (2)
Strap
b0837x2x
Header Support Mount Bolt ) Header Support Mount Voltage Regulator Mount Bracket Bolt Gr. 8
If necessary, remove header support mount. a. b. c. d. See Figure 2-94. Support motorcycle with jack. Remove bolts, locknuts and washers. Remove nuts and washers securing front mufer support to voltage regulator bracket and crankcase. Remove header support mount.
b0887x2x
Spacer
Washer
Exhaust Header
1. 2. Remove mufer. See Figure 2-95. Loosen the four exhaust header nuts (20) using SNAP-ON SWIVEL SOCKET (Part No. PFSX916). Disconnect oxygen sensor at connector [137]. See Figure 2-96. Remove exhaust header by swiveling and lifting exhaust header as shown. Slide exhaust header from behind frame. See Figure 2-97. Remove exhaust header clamps (22), exhaust clamp retaining rings (23) and exhaust port gaskets (24) from exhaust header. Jack Figure 2-94. Supporting Motorcycle with Jack
3. 4.
5.
2-58
HOME
b0835x2x
Z Bracket
Bolts (2) 22-24 ft-lbs (30-33 Nm) Washer (2) Spacer Washers (2)
Mount Tabs
Metal Locknut
Voltage
Regulator
2-59
HOME
ASSEMBLY/INSTALLATION
6813
Mufer
1. 2. If removed, install exhaust header. See Figure 2-95. If removed, install Z-bracket. a. b. Install rear mufer mounts and mount spacers on swingarm mount block. Attach Z-bracket with bolts, locknuts and washers. Bolt heads install on opposite side of the swingarm mount block from Z-bracket. Tighten to 22-24 ft-lbs (30-33 Nm).
3.
See Figure 2-93. If removed, attach header support mount to crankcase. a. b. c. Insert two front mufer mounts and mount spacer into mufer support. Install nuts and washers securing header support mount to voltage regulator bracket and crankcase. Attach header support mount to crankcase using two upper bolts. Tighten to 30-33 ft-lbs (41-45 Nm). Figure 2-96. Exhaust Header Positioning (Typical)
4.
Coat inside of mufer inlet with PERMATEX ULTRACOPPER HIGH TEMP RTV SILICON GASKET material.
NOTE If necessary, use a ber hammer to t mufer on header. 5. Place a new mufer clamp over mufer inlet. Place mufer and clamp on end of exhaust header. Snug clamp but do not tighten.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Before tightening mufer hardware, position mufer to provide adequate clearance from rear shock absorber, side stand spring post and rear tire. Failure to provide adequate clearance may cause loss of control during motorcycle operation which could result in death or serious injury. 6. See Figure 2-92. Position mufer and install to rear mounting support and weldnuts in rear mufer straps with two sets of bolts, washers and locknuts. Tighten to 22-24 ft-lbs (30-33 Nm). See Figure 2-93. Secure mufer to header support mount with bolt, locknut and washers. Tighten to 22-24 ft-lbs (30-33 Nm). When only the mufer is being replaced, tighten mufer clamp to 40-45 ft-lbs (54-61 Nm). If also installing the exhaust header, leave mufer clamp loose.
7.
8.
Exhaust Header
NOTE Mufer hardware must be tightened before tightening exhaust header hardware. 1. 2. 3. See Figure 2-97. Install new exhaust port gaskets (5) and exhaust clamp retaining rings (2). Slide exhaust header clamps (3) over ends of exhaust header (1). See Figure 2-96. Slide exhaust header under frame by positioning as shown, threading oxygen sensor wire under frame. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis
2-60
HOME
b0676x2x
4 3
1
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Exhaust Header Exhaust Header Nut (4) Exhaust Header Clamp (2) Exhaust Clamp Retaining Ring (2) Exhaust Port Gasket (2) Figure 2-97. Exhaust Header 4. 5. 6. Position rear end of exhaust header in port. Do not install exhaust header clamp over port. Rotate exhaust header so that front end of exhaust header is in position at front port to cylinder head. See Figure 2-97. Fasten exhaust header to cylinder heads with exhaust header clamps and nuts. Tighten the four exhaust header nuts to 6-8 ft-lbs (8-11 Nm) using SNAP-ON SWIVEL SOCKET (Part No. PFSX916). Install oxygen sensor to header if removed. Apply LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT to threads of sensor and install to exhaust header. Tighten sensor to 42-45 ft-lbs (57-61 Nm). Attach oxygen sensor connector [137]. Secure wiring and sensor with new cable ties. Tighten mufer clamp to 40-45 ft-lbs (54-61 Nm). On S3T models, install right fairing lower. See 2.38 FAIRING LOWERS (S3T).
7.
8. 9.
2-61
HOME
FOOTRESTS
REMOVAL
1. 2. See Figure 2-98. Remove locknut (1), bolt (2) and passenger footrests (3) from frame. Remove rider footrests from footrest mounts. a. b. Remove retaining ring (14) and washer (13) from pin (11). Hold hand over spring (12) and remove pin (11), spring (12) and footpeg (4) from mount (5).
b0369a2x
2.28
2 1
3 8 14 12 4
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
NOTE Locknuts for passenger footrests on S3T models are within the saddlebag support bracket. 3. If necessary, remove footrest mounts. a. If removing brake pedal mount, remove sprocket cover. See 2.29 SPROCKET COVER. Detach brake pedal from master cylinder push rod. If removing shift lever pedal mount, detach shift lever from shift rod. See Figure 2-98. Remove bolt (10) and washer (9) to detach footrest mount (5) from frame. Slide bushing (8), pedal and thrust washer (6) off footrest mount.
10 9
13 5
b. c. d.
11
Locknut (2) Bolt (2) Passenger Footrest (2) Rider Footrest (2) Footrest Mount (2) Thrust Washer (2) Rear Brake Pedal 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14.
7
Bushing (2) Washer (2) Bolt (2) Pin (2) Spring (2) Washer (2) Retaining Ring
INSTALLATION
1. See Figure 2-98. If removed, install passenger footrests. NOTE Tighten bolts (2) so footrests are tight, but not binding. a. b. 2. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 243 (blue) to footrest bolts (2). Install passenger footrests with allen bolts (2) and locknuts (1). Tighten to 24-30 ft-lbs (33-41 Nm). Slide thrust washer (6), shift/brake pedal and bushing (8) on footrest mount. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 272 (red) to bolt (10). Install footrest mount assembly using bolt (10) and washer (9). Tighten to 10-15 ft-lbs (14-20 Nm). Attach master cylinder push rod to brake pedal. Install sprocket cover. See 2.29 SPROCKET COVER. Attach shift lever to shift rod. Position spring (12) on mount (5) with thick side of spring inboard. Install pin (11) through spring (12), mount (5) and footrest (4). Install washer (13) and retaining ring (14) to pin. Make sure retaining ring engages groove on pin.
e. 3. a. b. c. 4.
Adjust shift lever and brake pedal for smooth operation. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Chassis
2-62
HOME
SPROCKET COVER
MODEL YEAR CHANGE
b0204x2a
2.29
Screws (2) 12-17 in-lbs (1-2 Nm) Purple Loctite
The sprocket cover on 2001 Buell Air Twin Models has been modied from previous years to allow for more clearance with the new rear isolators.
Spacer
REMOVAL/DISASSEMBLY
1. See Figure 2-99. On S3 models, remove locknut and washer from swingarm/drive support. See Figure 2-100. On S3T models, remove screw on fairing lower. Remove bracket from stud. See Figure 2-99. Remove two screws from swingarm/ drive support. Remove sprocket cover forward screw, washer and spacer. Remove swingarm drive/support and sprocket cover as an assembly. Remove two screws to separate sprocket cover from swingarm/drive support.
Sprocket Cover
2.
Screw 48-72 in-lbs Spacer (5-9 Nm) Blue Loctite Screws (2) 20-25 ft-lbs (27-34 Nm) Red Loctite Swingarm/Drive Support
3.
4.
5.
6.
8308
ASSEMBLY/INSTALLATION
1. See Figure 2-99. If removed, attach sprocket cover to swingarm/drive support. a. Place sprocket cover behind swingarm/drive support. Align holes in cover with holes in support. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 243 (blue) to both screws. Install screws. Tighten to 12-17 in-lbs (1-2 Nm).
3 2 1
b.
c. 2.
Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 243 (blue) to forward screw. Install sprocket cover assembly with screw, washer and spacer. Tighten to 48-72 in-lbs (5-9 Nm). Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 272 (red) to two swingarm/drive support screws and install. Tighten screws to 20-25 ft-lbs (27-34 Nm). See Figure 2-100. On S3T models, place fairing lower bracket on stud. Fasten fairing lower to bracket using screw. See Figure 2-99. On S3 models, install locknut and washer. Tighten locknut to 30-35 ft-lbs (41-47 Nm). 1. 2. 3. 4. Nut Bracket Screw and Wellnut Right Fairing Lower Figure 2-100. S3T Fairing Lower Mount
3.
4.
5.
2-63
HOME
STONE GUARD
REMOVAL
1. 2. See Figure 2-101. Remove two screws (1) and washers (2) securing lower belt guard (3) to swing arm. Remove lower belt guard (3), stone guard (4) and wellnuts (5) from swing arm.
b0612x2x
2.30
INSTALLATION
1. 2. See Figure 2-101. Position stone guard (4) with wellnuts (5) and lower belt guard (3) on swing arm. Secure with two screws (1) and washers (2). 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
3 1 2
Screw (2) Washer (2) Lower Belt Guard Stone Guard Wellnut (2) Figure 2-101. Stone Guard
2-64
HOME
FRONT FENDER
REMOVAL
1. 2. 3. Remove front wheel. See 2.5 FRONT WHEEL. See Figure 2-102. Remove both lower mounting screws (metric) and washers (7). Remove upper mounting screws (1, 5) and washer and spacer (3) on each side. Do not remove brake line guide (2) and speedometer cable guide (6) from around lines/ cables unless necessary. Carefully slide fender downward between fork legs.
b0407x2x
2.31
8 6 5 3
2 4 1
4.
INSTALLATION
1. Place washer and spacer (3) around brake line guide (2) as shown in Figure 2-102. The guide retaining loop points outward and back. Install screw (1) through assembly, but do not tighten at this time. Place washer and spacer (3) around speedometer cable guide (6). The guide retaining loop points outward and back. Install screw (5) through assembly, but do not tighten at this time. Install lower mounting screws (7) (metric). Plastic washer ts between fork leg and back of fender. Tighten to 10-15 in-lbs (1-2 Nm). Tighten upper mounting screws (1, 5) to 20-25 in-lbs (23 Nm). Install front wheel. See 2.5 FRONT WHEEL. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
2.
Screw Brake Line Guide Washer and Spacer (2) Locknut (2) Screw Speedometer Cable Guide Screw (metric) and Washer (2) Front Fender Figure 2-102. Front Fender
3.
4. 5.
2-65
HOME
REAR FENDER
REMOVAL
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Have someone sit on the vehicle to compress the motorcycles suspension. See Figure 2-103. Remove two screws (1) and washers (2) from right side wellnuts (4). Remove screw (5) and washer (6) from front wellnut (7). Remove screw (8) washer (9) from brake line clamp on the left side. Pull fender over rear tire.
b0608x2x
2.32
INSTALLATION
1. See Figure 2-104. Position fender over tire, making sure that the brake hose is on the outside of the fender as shown. See Figure 2-103. Secure clamp with screw (8) and washer (9). Have someone sit on the motorcycle to compress the motorcycles suspension. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 243 (blue) to all screws. a. b. Install screw (5) and washer (6) into wellnut (7). Install screws (1) and washers (2) into wellnuts (4). 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9.
3 1 2
2. 3. 4.
4
Screw (2) Washer (2) Fender Wellnut (2) Screw Washer Wellnut Screw Washer Figure 2-103. Rear Fender
6883
2-66
HOME
TAIL SECTION
REMOVAL
Tail Section
7
1. Remove both saddlebags from S3T models. a. Place ignition key in saddlebag lock. Turn key 1/4 turn. Open saddlebag cover and remove saddlebag liner. Remove saddlebag from support brackets by turning the three fasteners counterclockwise.
8309
2.33
3 4
b. c.
2.
See Figure 2-105. Remove seat. a. b. c. Place ignition key in seat lock (1). Turn key 1/4 turn. Pull seat release lever under the tail section. Lift seat away from motorcycle. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Seat Lock Helmet Bracket (2) Screw and Plastic Washer (4) Strike Plate Screw Self Tapping Screw (2) Fuel Tank Bolt Figure 2-105. Tail Section Hardware
3.
See 4.36 FUEL TANK for information on removing fuel tank from frame. 4. Remove two screws from tail lamps lens. Remove lens and set aside. Remove four screws and plastic washers (3) from tail section. Remove helmet brackets (2) from longer rear screws. Remove three screws (5, 6) from seat strike plate (4). Lift fuel tank and withdraw tail section from frame.
b0433x2x
5.
6. 7.
4 6
Unplug tail lamp/brake light connections and remove tail lamp mount. See 7.13 TAIL LAMP. Remove rear turn signals. See 7.14 TURN SIGNALS. See Figure 2-106. Remove bolts, washers and nuts (1) holding glove box (2) to license plate holder (3) and frame. Lift and remove glove box. Slide wiring harness through hole in side. See Figure 2-107. On S3T models, you may remove bolts, washers and nuts (2) to detach rear saddlebag support bracket (3) from turn signal support bracket (1). 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Bolt, Washer and Nut (2) Glove Box License Plate Holder Turn Signal Support Bracket Bolt, Washer and Nut (2) Rear Saddlebag Support Bracket Figure 2-106. Glove Box
3. 4.
5.
6.
2-67
HOME
INSTALLATION
Tail Section
1. 2. Install glove box and license plate holder if removed. Lift fuel tank and place tail section on frame. Align tail section with mounting holes in frame.
6297
1 2
NOTE If fuel tank was removed, see 4.36 FUEL TANK. 3. See Figure 2-105. Loosely install strike plate (4) using three screws. Both self tapping screws (6) t in forward holes of strike plate. Install tail section hardware. a. b. Loosely install two short screws with plastic washers (4) in the forward mounting holes. Place a helmet bracket (2) over a long screw (3). Place plastic washer under helmet bracket. Loosely install as an assembly in the rear mounting holes. Tighten all fasteners (3, 4, 5 and 6) in a crosswise pattern until snug. 1. 2. 3. Turn Signal Support Bracket Bolt, Washer and Nut (2) Rear Saddlebag Support Bracket (S3T) Figure 2-107. Saddlebag Brackets
4.
c. 5. 6.
Install fuel tank bolt. See 4.36 FUEL TANK. Install tail lamp lens with two screws.
6298
11 1WARNING WARNING
Check for proper brake lamp operation before riding motorcycle (see Step 7). Visibility is a major concern for motorcyclists. Failure to have proper brake lamp operation could result in death or serious injury. 7. Turn ignition key switch to IGN. Apply rear brake pedal to test brake lamp operation. Turn ignition key switch to LOCK.
3 1
11 1WARNING WARNING
After installing seat, pull upward on front of seat to be sure it is locked in position. If seat is loose, it could shift during vehicle operation and startle the rider, causing loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 8. 9. Install and lock seat. See 2.35 SEAT. Attach saddlebags to S3T models. See 2.37 SADDLEBAGS (S3T). 1. 2. 3. 4. Bolt, Washer and Nut (2) Glove Box License Plate Holder Tail Lamp Wiring
2. 3. 4. 5.
2-68
HOME
FRONT FAIRING
REMOVAL
Front Fairing
1. 2. See Figure 2-109. Remove both fairing bags (4) from S3T models. Remove both front turn signals (7). a. b. 3. Disconnect bullet connectors on turn signal wires. Remove nut and screw (6) to detach turn signals. Use caution not to scratch front fairing.
b0424x2x
2.34
1
4 1 3
Remove two nuts (metric) on each mirror (5). Remove mirrors while supporting front fairing. Pull front fairing away from front fairing bracket. Remove six screws and washers (1) to separate windshield (2) from front fairing (3).
4.
7 6
Screw, Washer and Wellnut (6) Windshield Front Fairing Fairing Bag (2) Mirror (2) (4 metric Nuts not shown) Screw (2) (2 Nuts not shown) Turn Signal (2) Figure 2-109. Front Fairing
NOTE If replacing front fairing mount, remove headlamp. 4. 5. Cut all cable straps holding wiring to front fairing mount. Note routing of wires before removing wires from mount. See Figure 2-110. Remove two locknuts (1), washers (2) and bolts (3) to detach front fairing mount from steering head.
b0425x2x
3 4 2
1. 2. 3. 4.
Locknut (2) Washer (2) Bolt (2) Front Fairing Mount Figure 2-110. Front Fairing Mount
2-69
HOME
INSTALLATION
Front Fairing Mount
1. Align and install front fairing mount on frame. a. b. c. See Figure 2-111. Front brake line (5) must run on gearcase cover side of fairing mount. Throttle cables (6) and all other wiring must run on primary cover side of fairing mount. See Figure 2-110. Attach fairing mount to steering head using two locknuts (1), washers (2) and bolts (3). Tighten to 22-25 ft-lbs (30-34 Nm).
6287
4 3 1 5 2 6
2. 3. 4. 5.
Install and/or connect headlamp. See 7.12 HEADLAMP. See Figure 2-112. Use new cable straps (3) to secure wires (1, 2) to front fairing mount. Install dash panel and both gauges. See 2.26 HANDLEBARS. Install front fairing. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
Front Fairing
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. See Figure 2-109. Attach windshield to front fairing using six screws and washers (1). Align front fairing on front fairing mount. Loosely install both mirrors (5) using two nuts (metric) on each. Install front turn signals (7). See 7.14 TURN SIGNALS. Tighten both nuts (metric) on mirrors to 7-10 in-lbs (0.81.1 Nm). Install both fairing bags (4) on S3T models.
Right Hand Control Cables Left Hand Control Cables Handlebar Clamp on Upper Triple Clamp Fork Tube Front Brake Line Throttle Cables Figure 2-111. Front Fairing Mount Alignment
2
1. 2. 3. Right Turn Signal Wires Left Turn Signal Wires Cable Straps Figure 2-112. Cable Straps
b0469x2x
2-70
HOME
SEAT
REMOVAL
Seat
1. 2. 3. See Figure 2-113. Place ignition key in seat lock. Turn key 1/4 turn. Pull seat release lever under the tail section. Lift seat and remove.
6288
2.35
Seat Lock
1. 2. 3. Remove seat. See Figure 2-114. Remove locknut (10) and star washer (9) from lock (2). Slowly remove seat tang (8). As seat tang is lowered, cam (7) will follow. Note orientation of cam (top/bottom and slot position) for later installation. Remove nut (6). Remove D-washer (5) and O-ring (4). Pull lock (2) and O-ring (3) from top of tail section. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. Key Lock O-Ring O-Ring D-Washer Nut Cam Seat Tang Star Washer Locknut Figure 2-113. Removing Seat
4. 5. 6.
1 2 3
Seat Release
1. 2. Remove seat. See Figure 2-115. Remove shoulder bolt (1), spring (2) and washer (3) from frame.
NOTE Depending upon vehicle production date, some S3T models may have a remote seat release handle. This handle attaches to the seat latch lever via a cable. 3. Remove seat latch lever (4) and bushing (5).
b0432x2x
4 5 7 9 10 6 8
INSTALLATION
Seat
1. 2. See Figure 2-116. Install seat by sliding metal locating tab (2) on bottom of seat under frame tab (3). Press down on seat until seat release lever clicks. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
11 1WARNING WARNING
After installing seat, pull upward on front of seat to be sure it is locked in position. If seat is loose, it could shift during vehicle operation and startle the rider, causing loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 3. See Figure 2-113. Turn ignition key 1/4 turn. Remove key from seat lock. NOTE Seat lock must be in the locked position before ignition key may be removed. See Figure 2-116. Metal tabs on tail section are helmet brackets (1). Place helmet D-ring under tab. Install and lock seat to secure helmet for storage while motorcycle is stationary.
5 3 1 2
b0434x2x
2-71
HOME
b0311aox 6308
3 2 3 1 2
1. 2.
3.
Frame Tab
1. 2. 3. 4.
Seat Tang Cam O-Ring Lock Figure 2-117. Installing Seat Lock
Seat Lock
1. See Figure 2-117. Place O-ring (3) and lock (4) in tail section as shown. See Figure 2-114. Install O-ring (4) and D-washer (5). Secure seat lock using nut (6). Tighten nut until seat lock does not rotate in tail section. See Figure 2-117. Position cam (2) on seat tang (1). Install assembly on lock. See Figure 2-114. Install star washer (9) and nut (10). Test lock action. a. Key should only be removable in the locked position. Check cam (7) position if there is problem. Seat tang and key should smoothly rotate without binding. If assembly binds, remove and reinstall. 1. 2. 3. 4. Shoulder Bolt Spring Washer Seat Latch Lever Figure 2-118. Installing Seat Release 4. Align seat release assembly under tail section. Secure with shoulder bolt (1). Shoulder bolt must not compress washer or seat latch lever. If installed, attach remote seat release cable to seat latch lever on S3T models.
b0441x2x
2.
3.
4. 5.
b.
11 1WARNING WARNING
After installing seat, pull upward on front of seat to be sure it is locked in position. If seat is loose, it could shift during vehicle operation and startle the rider, causing loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 6. Install seat and test as described.
5.
Seat Release
1. See Figure 2-115. Place bushing (5) on top of seat latch lever (4). See Figure 2-118. Place washer (3) and spring (2) under seat latch lever (4). Hook edge of spring (2) over seat latch lever (4). Small loop of spring will rest against frame as shown.
11 1WARNING WARNING
After installing seat, pull upward on front of seat to be sure it is locked in position. If seat is loose, it could shift during vehicle operation and startle the rider, causing loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 6. Install seat and test as described.
2.
3.
2-72
HOME
SIDE STAND
GENERAL 11 1WARNING WARNING
G
8305
2.36
Sidestand Switch
If the side stand is not in the full forward position when vehicle weight is rested on it, the vehicle could fall over which could result in death or serious injury. Always park motorcycle on a level, rm surface. Vehicle weight could cause motorcycle to fall over, which could result in death or serious injury. Plunger
Bumper
The side stand is located on the left side of the motorcycle. The side stand swings outward to support the motorcycle for parking. See Figure 2-119. The side stand activates the side stand switch which is part of the starter interlock system. See 7.6 STARTER INTERLOCK for more information.
REMOVAL/DISASSEMBLY
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Raise rear wheel off oor using REAR WHEEL SUPPORT STAND (Part No. B-41174). See Figure 2-120. Remove spring (6) from side stand and spring pin (5). Remove retaining clip (7) and pivot pin (8). Detach side stand from frame. Remove bumper (3) from frame. Remove screw (2) and side stand dragger (1).
1 2 3 4 6 5
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
Side Stand Dragger Screw Bumper Side Stand Spring Pin Spring Retaining Clip Pivot Pin
8 7
b0435x2x
INSPECTION
1. 2. Replace dragger when worn to wear line shown in Figure 2-121. Test the side stand in the following manner. Without vehicle weight resting on it, side stand should move freely into extended (down) and retracted (up) positions. Check sidestand switch (starter interlock) for proper operation after the rst 500 miles and every 2500 miles thereafter. See 7.6 STARTER INTERLOCK.
6299
3.
ASSEMBLY/INSTALLATION
1. 2. 3. See Figure 2-120. Attach bumper (3) to frame. Attach side stand dragger (1) to side stand with screw (2). Apply LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE to pivot pin (8). Install side stand using pivot pin (8) and retaining clip (7). Do not crush side stand switch during installation. Connect spring (6) to side stand and spring pin (5). Remove REAR WHEEL STAND.
4. 5.
2-73
HOME
SADDLEBAGS (S3T)
GENERAL 11 1WARNING WARNING
Keep cargo weight concentrated close to the motorcycle and as low as possible to minimize the change in the motorcycles center of gravity. Distribute weight evenly on both sides of the vehicle and do not load bulky items too far behind the rider or add weight to the handlebars or front forks. Do not load saddlebag beyond maximum weight capacity. See label inside saddlebag for weight capacity limit. Improper loading can adversely affect handling which could result in death or serious injury. See Figure 2-122. Each saddlebag features a barrel-style lock and a removable saddlebag liner. See Figure 2-123. Two different sizes of saddlebag covers are available. Exchange covers by opening saddlebag cover to 90. Opening (3) in saddlebag cover hinge mates with corresponding tab (2) on saddlebag body hinge. 1. 2. 3. Right Saddlebag Lock and Latch Fasteners (3)
2.37
b0554aox
OPERATION
1. 2. See Figure 2-122. Place ignition key in saddlebag lock (2). Turn key 1/4 turn. Lift saddlebag latch.
3
CAUTION Do not rest items on an open saddlebag cover. Placing objects on an open saddlebag cover could damage cover and mounting hardware. CAUTION Make sure contents do not interfere with cover seal when closing. If seal is disturbed, bags will not close properly. 3. Open cover and remove saddlebag liner.
1 2 4
REMOVAL
See Figure 2-122. Three fasteners (3) attach each saddlebag to the support brackets. 1. Unlock and unload saddlebag. Figure 2-123. S3T Saddlebag Cover Hinge 1. 2. 3. 4. Saddlebag Body Tab on Hinge Opening in Hinge Saddlebag Cover
b0625xox
11 1WARNING WARNING
Saddlebag support brackets are not grab handles for passenger. Using support bracket as a passenger grab handle could result in death or serious injury. 2. 3. Pull fastener handle open. Turn handle 1/4 turn to release saddlebag from support bracket.
2-74
HOME
INSTALLATION
1. Align molded channels on rear of saddlebag with support brackets. CAUTION Be sure saddlebag is fully seated on bracket. Failure to do so could result in the saddlebags becoming detached and/or damaged. CAUTION Do not slam saddlebag lids closed. Excessive force will damage saddlebags. 2. See Figure 2-124. Attach saddlebags to brackets by turning fasteners 1/4 turn to the rear. Handles will be parallel to molded channels inside saddlebag. Gently push fastener handles closed, do not force. Install saddlebag liner. Close cover by aligning hooks on saddlebag cover with openings on saddlebag body and rmly pushing inward. Do not force saddlebag covers closed. Lock saddlebag and remove key. See Figure 2-125. If saddlebags are difcult to close or install, check rear saddlebag bracket alignment on both sides. a. b. c. d. e. Slide rubber boot away from bumper assembly. Turn bumper (2) counterclockwise until it contacts saddlebag (3). Turn bumper one additional full turn counterclockwise. Tighten jamnut (1) against rear saddlebag support bracket. Slide rubber boot over bumper assembly.
6990
1. 2.
3.
4. 5.
1
1. 2. 3. Jamnut Bumper Saddlebag
b0438x2x
2-75
HOME
2.38
8 2 7 2 6 3
1 3 4 2 3 2
Left Side
1. 2. 3. 4. Remove seat and fuel tank screw. See 2.35 SEAT. See Figure 2-126. Remove screw (2), clamp (7), nylon washer (3) and locknut (6) from left fairing lower (8). Disengage clamp (7) from metal bracket on fairing lower. Lift fuel tank and remove left fairing lower.
INSTALLATION
8310
Right Side
1. 2. See Figure 2-126. Attach fairing lower (1) to bracket (4) with screw (2), nylon washer (3) and locknut (6). Install two screws (2), nylon washers (3) and locknuts (6) to air cleaner cover bracket.
Left Side
1. 2. Lift fuel tank and insert fairing lower lip over frame tube. See Figure 2-127. Align clamp with metal bracket on fairing lower. Place nylon washer between clamp and metal bracket. Insert screw through clamp, nylon washer, metal bracket and opposite side of clamp. Fasten with locknut. Tighten fuel tank screw to 18-23 ft-lbs (24-31 Nm). Wait ve minutes and tighten again to 18-23 ft-lbs (24-31 Nm).
3.
11 1WARNING WARNING
After installing seat, pull upward on front of seat to be sure it is locked in position. If seat is loose, it could shift during vehicle operation and startle the rider, causing loss of control which could result in death or serious injury. 4. Install seat. See 2.35 SEAT.
2-76
ENGINE
Table Of Contents
SUBJECT
PAGE NO. 3-1 3-5 3-8 3-10 3-12 3-24 3-31 3-32 3-33 3-34 3-35 3-36 3-37 3-40 3-41 3-43 3-50
3.1 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3 Stripping Motorcycle For Engine Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.4 Installing The Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 Cylinder Head . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6 Cylinder and Piston . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.7 Lubrication System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8 Oil Hose Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.9 Oil Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.10 Oil Pressure Indicator Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.11 Crankcase Breathing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.12 Oiling System (Color Foldout) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.13 Oil Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.14 Oil Filter Mount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.15 Hydraulic Lifters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.16 Gearcase Cover and Cam Gears . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.17 Crankcase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
HOME
SPECIFICATIONS
CAMSHAFT SPECIFICATIONS GENERAL Number of Cylinders Type Horsepower Torque Compression Ratio Bore Stroke Engine Displacement Oil Tank Capacity (with lter change) 2 Air cooled, four-stroke 45 Degree V-twin 101 @ 6200 RPM 90 ft-lbs @ 5500 RPM 10.0 to 1 3.498 in. 3.8125 in. 73.4 cu. in. 2.0 quarts 88.849 mm 96.838 mm 1203 cc 1.89 liters Spark Plug Gap Spark Plug Torque Type Regular Idle Spark Plug Size Spark Plug Type Timing @ 0.053 Lift Open/Close
3.1
ENGINE IGNITION SPECIFICATIONS Sequential, non waste spark 850-1050 RPM 12 mm Harley-Davidson No. 10R12 0.038-0.043 in. 11-18 ft-lbs 0.97-1.09 mm 15-24 Nm
CAMSHAFT SPECIFICATIONS Lift @ Valve (TDC) Intake/Exhaust Duration @ 0.053 Lift Intake/Exhaust 0.211 in./0.191 in.
NOTE Service wear limits are given as a guideline for measuring components that are not new. For measurement specications not given under SERVICE WEAR LIMITS, see NEW COMPONENTS.
256/256
ITEM VALVE Fit in guide Seat width Stem protrusion from cylinder valve pocket OUTER VALVE SPRING Free length Intake 1.751-1.848 in. (closed) 1.286-1.383 in. (open) Exhaust 1.751-1.848 in. (closed) 1.332-1.429 in. (open) Exhaust Intake
NEW COMPONENTS
2.105-2.177 in. 72-92 lbs 183-207 lbs 72-92 lbs 171-195 lbs
53.467 mm (min)
3-1
HOME
ITEM INNER VALVE SPRING Free length Intake 1.577-1.683 in. (closed) 1.112-1.218 in. (open) Exhaust 1.577-1.683 in. (closed) 1.158-1.264 in. (open) ROCKER ARM Shaft t in bushing (loose) End clearance Bushing t in rocker arm (tight) ROCKER ARM SHAFT Shaft t in rocker cover (loose) PISTON Compression ring gap (top and 2nd) Oil control ring rail gap Compression ring side clearance Top 2nd
NEW COMPONENTS
1.926-1.996 in. 38-49 lbs 98-112 lbs 38-49 lbs 91-106 lbs
48.920 (min)
0.0889 mm 0.635 mm
0.0007-0.0022 in.
0.018-0.056 mm
0.0035 in.
0.0889 mm
0.007-0.020 in. 0.009-0.052 in. 0.0020-0.0045 in. 0.0016-0.0041 in. 0.0016-0.0076 in. 0.00005-0.00045 in.
0.032 in. 0.065 in 0.0065 in. 0.0065 in. 0.0094 in. 0.00100 in.
Oil control ring side clearance Pin t (loose, at room temperature) CYLINDER HEAD Valve guide in head (tight) Valve seat in head (tight) Head gasket surface (atness) CYLINDER Taper Out of round Warpage (gasket surfaces) Bore diameter 0.0002 in. Top Base Standard 0.005 OS 0.010 OS 0.020 OS OS=over size 0.030 OS
0.002 in. 0.003 in. 0.006 in. 0.008 in. 3.4978 in. 3.502 in. 3.507 in. 3.517 in. 3.527 in. 88.8441 mm 88.951 mm 89.078 mm 89.332 mm 89.586 mm 3.5008 in. 3.5050 in. 3.5100 in. 3.5200 in. 3.5300 in.
3-2
HOME ITEM CONNECTING ROD Piston pin t (loose) Side play between ywheels Fit on crankpin (loose) Connecting rod race ID LIFTER Fit in guide Roller t Roller end clearance OIL PUMP Oil pressure 1000 RPM 2500 RPM 7-12 PSI 10-17 PSI 0.0025 in. 0.003 in. 48-83 kN/m2 69-117 kN/m2 0.0635 mm 0.076 mm 0.004 in. 0.102 mm 0.0008-0.0020 in. 0.0006-0.0010 in. 0.008-0.022 in. 0.0203-0.0508 mm 0.0152-0.0254 mm 0.203-0.559 mm 0.0030 in. 0.0015 in. 0.026 in. 0.0762 mm 0.0381 mm 0.660 mm 0.00125-0.00175 in. 0.005-0.025 in. 0.0004-0.0017 in. 1.6245-1.6250 in. 0.03175-0.04445 mm 0.127-0.635 mm 0.0102-0.0432 mm 41.2623-41.2750 mm 0.00200 in. 0.030 in. 0.0027 in. 1.6270 in. 0.05080 mm 0.762 mm 0.0686 mm 41.3258 mm NEW COMPONENTS SERVICE WEAR LIMITS
Shaft to pump clearance Feed/scavenge inner/outer gerotor clearance GEARCASE Cam gear shaft in bushing (loose) Cam gear shaft end play (min) (except rear intake) Rear intake cam gear shaft end play (min) FLYWHEEL Runout Flywheels at rim Shaft at ywheel end End play SPROCKET SHAFT BEARING Outer race t in crankcase (tight) Bearing inner race t on shaft (tight) PINION SHAFT BEARINGS Pinion shaft jounal diameter Outer race diameter in right crankcase Bearing running clearance Fit in cover bushing (loose)
0.0102-0.0610 mm 0.0051-0.0381 mm
0.0050 in.
0.1270 mm
3-3
HOME
TORQUE VALUES
ITEM Anti-Rotation Screws Crankcase 1/4 in. Screws Crankcase 5/16 in. Screws Cylinder Head Screws
TORQUE 80-110 in-lbs 70-110 in-lbs 15-18 ft-lbs 7-9 ft-lbs then 13-15 ftlbs then loosen and repeat torque sequence 10-20 ft-lbs 9-12 Nm 8-12 Nm 20-24 Nm 10-12 Nm then 18-20 Nm then loosen and repeat torque sequence 14-27 Nm
NOTES
Cylinder Studs Front Isolator to Cylinder Head Bolt Isolator Bolt (Front) Isolator TORX Bolts (Rear) Oil Filter Adapter Oil Pressure Switch Signal Light
special method to tighten Special Procedure: Oiled THREADLOCKER 271 (red) Washers, LOCTITE
Special Procedure: 60 ft-lbs (81 Nm), back off one full turn and retighten to 60 ft-lbs (81 Nm). 100-110 ft-lbs 63-70 ft-lbs 8-12 ft-lbs 4-6 ft-lbs 125-150 in-lbs 125-150 in-lbs 35-45 ft-lbs 10-14 ft-lbs 10-14 ft-lbs 130-150 inlbs 15-19 ft-lbs 68-75 ft-lbs 41-45 ft-lbs 30-33 ft-lbs 136-149 Nm 85-95 Nm 11-16 Nm 5-8 Nm 14-17 Nm 14-17 Nm 48-61 Nm 14-19 Nm 14-19 Nm 15-17 Nm 20-26 Nm 92-102 Nm 56-61 Nm 41-45 Nm
LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 262 (red), LOCTITE ANTI-SEIZE under bolt heads LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 243 (blue)
Oil Pump Cover Screws Oil Pump Mounting Screws Pinion Shaft Nut Rocker Box Bolts Rocker Box Cover Screws Rocker Box Screws Rocker Box to Head Bolts Swingarm Mount Block Bolts (Lower) Swingarm Mount Block Bolts (Upper) Tie Bar Bolts
2 sizes
3-4
HOME
ENGINE
MODEL YEAR CHANGE
All 2001 Model Year ThunderstormTM engines are equipped with a new oil pump with increased scavenging ability, high contact ratio cam gears and Harley-Davidson No. 10R12 spark plugs. Cylinders on M2/M2L models, clutch covers and clutch inspection covers are now powder-coated black. Pushrod tubes and starters are now painted black. The two-piece intake manifold seals remain for the model year.
3.2
FUEL
Gasoline/alcohol Blends
Buell motorcycles were designed to obtain the best performance and efciency using unleaded gasoline (91 pump octane or higher). Some fuel suppliers sell gasoline/alcohol blends as a fuel. The type and amount of alcohol added to the fuel is important.
G
GENERAL
The ThunderstormTM high performance engine is a two-cylinder, four-cycle, air-cooled, overhead-valve V-twin. It has three major component assemblies.
DO NOT USE GASOLINES CONTAINING METHANOL. Using gasoline/methanol blends will result in starting and driveability deterioration and damage to critical fuel system components. ETHANOL is a mixture of 10% ethanol (Grain alcohol) and 90% unleaded gasoline. Gasoline/ethanol blends can be used in your motorcycle if the ethanol content does not exceed 10%. Gasolines containing ETHER: Gasoline/ether blends are a mixture of gasoline and as much as 15% ether. Gasoline/ether blends can be used in your motorcycle if the ether content does not exceed 17%. REFORMULATED OR OXYGENATED GASOLINES (RFG): Reformulated gasoline is a term used to describe gasoline blends that are specically designed to burn cleaner than other types of gasoline, leaving fewer tailpipe emissions. They are also formulated to evaporate less when you are lling your tank. Reformulated gasolines use additives to oxygenate the gas. Your motorcycle will run normally using this type of gas. Buell recommends you use it when possible, as an aid to cleaner air in our environment.
Cylinder
The cylinder assembly includes cylinder head, valves, rocker arm cover, rocker arms and piston. Cylinders mount on the crankcase in a 45 degree V with both connecting rods connected to a single crank pin. Thunderstorm engines have modied cylinder heads with a black nish and unique pistons.
G
Crankcase
The up-and-down motion of the piston in the cylinder is converted to circular motion in the crankcase. The multi-piece crankshaft consists of a crank pin mounted between two counterweighted ywheels, which rotate on two end shaft bearings. The lower end of the rear cylinder connecting rod is forked to t around the single-end front cylinder connecting rod, allowing a single connecting rod crank pin connection to the ywheel.
Gearcase
The gearcase is located on the right side of the crankcase. The gearcase houses the gear train, which operates and times the valves and ignition. The cam gear train, consisting of four cam shafts with one cam lobe on each shaft, is gear driven. The engine valves are opened and closed through the mechanical linkage of lifters, push rods and rocker arms. Hydraulic lifters automatically compensate for heat expansion to maintain the no-lash t of valve train components. Lifters serve to transmit the cam action to the valve linkage. Valve timing is obtained by aligning timing marks when installing cam gears. Ignition spark is produced by the operation of a microprocessor-controlled electronic control module (ECM), ignition coil and spark plugs. Spark timing is determined by a trigger rotor, magnetic sensing unit and the ECM. The trigger rotor has six openings which time the cylinders and communicate engine speed to the ECM. The spark plugs re independently during the compression stroke on each cylinder (no waste spark).
Because of their generally higher volatility, these blends may adversely affect the starting, driveability and fuel efciency of your motorcycle. If you experience these problems, Buell recommends you operate your motorcycle on straight, unleaded gasoline.
LUBRICATION
The engine has a force-feed (pressure) type oiling system, incorporating oil feed and return pumps in one pump body, with one check valve on the oil feed side. The feed pump forces oil to the engine, lubricating lower connecting rod bearings, rocker arm bushings, valve stems, valve springs, push rods and hydraulic lifters. Cylinder walls, pistons, piston pins, timing gears and bushings and main bearings are lubricated by oil spray thrown off connecting rods and crankshaft, and by oil draining from each rocker box through an internal drain passage in each cylinder and each lifter guide. A small amount of oil is sprayed through an oil galley jet onto the rear intake cam gear in the gearcase; oil is transferred to the teeth of all the cam gears by way of the gear meshing action. The oil-scavenging section of the pump returns oil to the tank from the engine. See 3.7 LUBRICATION SYSTEM for more information. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Engine 3-5
HOME
ADJUSTMENT/TESTING
General
When an engine needs repair, it is not always possible to determine denitely beforehand whether repair is possible with only cylinder heads, cylinders and pistons disassembled or whether complete engine disassembly is required for crankcase repair. Most commonly, only cylinder head and cylinder repair is needed (valves, rings, piston, etc.) and it is recommended procedure to service these units rst, allowing engine crankcase to remain in frame. See 3.3 STRIPPING MOTORCYCLE FOR ENGINE REPAIR to strip motorcycle for removal of cylinder heads, cylinders, and pistons. After disassembling upper end only, it may be found that crankcase repair is necessary. In this situation, remove the engine crankcase from the chassis. See 3.3 STRIPPING MOTORCYCLE FOR ENGINE REPAIR. CAUTION If engine is removed from chassis, do not lay engine on primary side. Placing engine on primary side will damage clutch cable end tting. If tting is damaged, clutch cable must be replaced. Symptoms indicating a need for engine repair are often misleading, but generally, if more than one symptom is present, possible causes can be narrowed down to make at least a partial diagnosis. An above-normal consumption of oil, for example, could be caused by several mechanical faults. See 1.22 TROUBLESHOOTING. However, when accompanied by blue-gray exhaust smoke and low engine compression, it indicates the piston rings need replacing. Low compression by itself, however, may indicate improperly seated valves, in addition to or in lieu of worn piston rings. Most frequently, valves, rings, pins, bushings, and bearings need attention at about the same time. If the possible causes can be narrowed down through the process of elimination to indicate any one of the above components is worn, it is best to give attention to all of the cylinder head and cylinder parts.
4. 5. 6. 7.
8.
Valve trouble
3-6
HOME
9.
After completing the compression test(s), make sure that the throttle plate is in the closed position before starting engine. Engine will start at an extremely high RPM if throttle plate is left open.
Head Gasket
7.
Valve guide seals. Valve guide-to-valve stem clearance. Gasket surface of both head and cylinder. Oil return passages for clogging.
8.
3-7
HOME
3.3
1 TON N 3/4 TO
Floor Hoist
b.
11 1WARNING WARNING
To protect against shock and accidental start-up of vehicle, disconnect the negative battery cable before proceeding. Inadequate safety precautions could result in death or serious injury.
11 1WARNING WARNING
Always disconnect the negative battery cable rst. If the positive cable should contact ground with the negative cable installed, the resulting sparks may cause a battery explosion which could result in death or serious injury. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Disconnect both battery cables, negative cable rst. Remove seat and fuel tank. See 4.36 FUEL TANK. Remove left and right fairing lower from S3T models. See 2.38 FAIRING LOWERS (S3T). Remove air cleaner cover and backplate. See 4.41 AIR CLEANER. Remove throttle body, intake manifold and ignition key switch bracket. See 4.40 THROTTLE BODY AND INTAKE MANIFOLD. Remove exhaust header EXHAUST SYSTEM. and mufer. See 2.27 Figure 3-1. Floor Hoist (Typical) 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. Remove rear fender and lower belt guard. See 2.32 REAR FENDER. Remove sprocket cover. See 2.29 SPROCKET COVER. Detach rear brake caliper from caliper mount. See 2.14 REAR BRAKE CALIPER. Detach belt from rear sprocket and remove rear wheel. See 2.6 REAR WHEEL. Drain oil tank and remove oil lter. See 1.3 BATTERY.
10. Detach hoses from all three ttings on oil tank. See 3.9 OIL TANK. 11. Remove both rider footrest mounts from frame. See 2.28 FOOTRESTS. 12. Remove rear shock mounting bolt (metric) from swingarm. Allow rear shock to hang from front mount. 13. Disconnect wiring. See Section 7. a. b. c. d. e. f. Disconnect neutral switch wire from crankcase. Unplug cam position sensor from wiring harness. Disconnect sensor connectors from sensors. Remove solenoid wire, battery positive cable and circuit breaker charging wire from starter motor. Locate voltage regulator connector near the oil pump. Disconnect from alternator stator. Detach wire from oil pressure indicator switch. See 3.10 OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR SWITCH.
7. 8. 9.
Disconnect spark plug cables. Remove spark plugs. If removing front cylinder, remove ignition coil (7.4 IGNITION COIL) and horn (7.17 HORN).
10. If removing rear cylinder, remove the Engine Temperature Sensor. NOTE At this stage, the lower rocker boxes, cylinder heads and cylinders may be removed. See 3.5 CYLINDER HEAD.
3-8
HOME
b0251x3x b0202x3x
2
1. 2. 3. Ground Strap Rear Isolator Swingarm Mount Block Bolts (2, upper) Swingarm Mount Block Bolts (2, lower) Rubber Isolator (2) Lockwashers (2) Isolator TORX Bolts (2)
Crating Strap
4.
7
Figure 3-2. Supporting the Engine 14. See Figure 3-2. Place a wooden cradle underneath the crankcase. 15. Place a crating strap between the engine cylinders and around the lift. Tighten crating strap until snug. 16. See Figure 3-3. Remove engine ground strap (1) from swingarm mount block. 17. Detach remaining tie bars from frame. a. b. Remove rear tie bar using a swivel socket. See Figure 3-4. Detach front tie bar (1) and clutch cable clamp (3). Remove tie bar bolt (2), clutch cable clamp (3), washer (4) and locknut (5). Remove washer and nut to detach front upper tie bar (11) from isolator (8).
b0730x3x
5. 6. 7.
10 9
1. 2. 3.
c.
Front Lower Tie Bar Tie Bar Bolt Clutch Cable Clamp 4. Washer 5. Locknut 6. Front Isolator bolt 7. Washer 8. Front Isolator 9. D-Washer 10. Nut 11. Front Upper Tie Bar
18. Detach front isolator (8). Remove front isolator bolt (6), nut (10), D-washer (9) and washer (7). 19. See Figure 3-3. Remove isolator bolt (7) and lockwasher (6) on each side. 20. Slowly raise oor hoist until rubber isolators (5) can be removed. Frame will rise while engine remains secured to lift by crating strap. NOTE Rubber isolators align with a frame mounted metal pin. 21. Raise frame and walk forward over and away from the engine. 22. If necessary, remove rear swingarm. See 2.19 SWINGARM. 23. If necessary, detach swingarm mount block from powertrain by removing bolts (3, 4), washers and locknuts.
5 3 1 8 4 2
11
3-9
HOME
3.4
19. Install rear brake caliper. See 2.14 REAR BRAKE CALIPER. 20. Attach disconnected wires. See Section 7. a. b. c. d. e. Connect solenoid wire, circuit breaker charging wire and battery positive cable to starter. Connect voltage regulator connector to alternator stator wiring. Attach cam position sensor to wire harness. Connect neutral switch wire to crankcase. Attach oil pressure indicator switch wire.
3. 4.
21. Install rear fender and lower belt guard. See 2.32 REAR FENDER. 22. Install sprocket cover. See 2.29 SPROCKET COVER. 23. Install footrests. See 2.28 FOOTRESTS. 24. Continue with the steps listed under ENGINE INSTALLATION AFTER CYLINDER HEAD REPAIR.
5. 6.
7.
Install exhaust system. See 2.27 EXHAUST SYSTEM. Install air cleaner assembly. See 4.41 AIR CLEANER. If removed, install horn (7.17 HORN) and ignition coil (7.4 IGNITION COIL). Install spark plugs and connect cables. See 1.16 SPARK PLUGS.
9.
10. Attach front upper tie bar (11). Insert bolt through tie bar front isolator, and frame. Secure with nut and washer. Tighten to 30-33 ft-lbs (41-45 Nm). 11. See Figure 3-3. Tighten the two rear isolator TORX bolts to 63-70 ft-lbs (85-95 Nm) 12. See Figure 3-4. Tighten front isolator bolt (6) to 100-110 ft-lbs (136-149 Nm). 13. Connect feed, return and vent lines to oil tank. See 3.8 OIL HOSE ROUTING. Use new hose clamps. 14. Attach battery ground strap to swingarm mount block. 15. Attach clutch cable to handlebar lever. 16. Remove strap from between engine cylinders. Using a oor hoist, lift motorcycle by the frame and remove the wooden cradle from underneath the crankcase. 17. Install rear shock. See 2.21 REAR SHOCK ABSORBER. Remove oor hoist straps. 18. Install rear wheel and attach drive belt. See 2.6 REAR WHEEL. 3-10 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Engine
HOME
11 1WARNING WARNING
Always connect positive battery cable rst. If the positive cable should contact ground with the negative cable installed, the resulting sparks may cause a battery explosion which could result in death or serious injury. 7. 8. 9. Install battery. Connect battery cables, positive cable rst. Install left and right fairing lowers on S3T models. See 2.38 FAIRING LOWERS (S3T). Install tail section, fuel tank and seat. See 2.33 TAIL SECTION. a. b. c. d. Adjust rear belt deection. See 1.9 DRIVE BELT DEFLECTION. Adjust rear shock spring preload. See 1.12 PRELOAD ADJUSTMENT. Adjust clutch lever. See 1.8 CLUTCH. Check rear brake pedal height. See 1.5 BRAKES.
3-11
HOME
CYLINDER HEAD
REMOVAL
Before removing the cylinder head assembly, see 3.3 STRIPPING MOTORCYCLE FOR ENGINE REPAIR. The rocker arm covers and internal components must be removed before removing cylinder heads. 1. See Figure 3-5. Remove screws with washers (1) and ber seals (2). Discard ber seals. CAUTION All washers and fasteners used in the engine are hardened. Do not mix or replace hardened washers and fasteners with unhardened parts. Do not reuse ber cover seals. These actions may result in accelerated wear and increased noise. 2. 3. Remove upper (4) and middle (5) sections of rocker cover. Remove and discard gaskets (6, 7 and 8). Rotate crankshaft until piston on head being repaired reaches top dead center of compression stroke.
b0343x3x
3.5
1 2 4
3 6 5 7
12
10 14 13
NOTE Both valves in the cylinder head will be closed when viewed through the spark plug hole. 4. Remove hardware holding lower rocker cover to cylinder head in the following order. a. b. c. d. 5. Remove two screws and washers (14). Remove three bolts and washers (15). Remove the two rocker arm retaining bolts (12) near the push rods. Remove the remaining two rocker arm retaining bolts (13). 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19.
19
11 18 17
15 16
NOTE Remove lower rocker boxes as an assembly; then disassemble as required. 6. Mark the location and orientation (top/bottom) of each push rod. Remove push rods. CAUTION Mark rocker arm shafts for reassembly in their original positions. Valve train components must be reinstalled in their original positions to prevent accelerated wear and increased valve train noise. 7. 8. See Figure 3-6. Remove rocker arm shafts by tapping them out using a hammer and a soft metal punch. See Figure 3-5. Remove rocker arms (10, 11); mark them for reassembly in their original locations. CAUTION Distortion to the head, cylinder and crankcase studs may result if head screws are not loosened (or tightened) gradually in the sequence shown in Figure 3-7. 9. See Figure 3-7. Loosen each head screw 1/8-turn following the sequence shown. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Engine
Screws with Washers (4) Fiber Seal (4) Umbrella Valve (2) Upper Rocker Cover Middle Rocker Cover Gasket Gasket Gasket Rocker Arm Shafts Rocker Arm Rocker Arm Bolt and Washer (2) (long) Bolt and Washer (2) (short) Screw and Washer (2) Bolt and Washer (3) Gasket Gasket Lower Rocker Cover Rocker Arm Bushing (8) Figure 3-5. Rocker Arm Cover
3-12
HOME
5698
b0336x3x b0335x3x
Front Cylinder
1 2 3
4
1. 2. Position of Rocker Arm Retaining Bolts Retaining Notch Figure 3-6. Removing Rocker Arm Shafts
2
Rear Cylinder
CAUTION See Figure 3-8. Do not attempt to remove the front isolator mount from front cylinder head. Isolator mount is an integral component and is not meant to be removed unless absolutely necessary. Repeated removals and installations will damage cylinder head threads. 10. Support motorcycle under front header mount. Do not allow engine to drop when performing the next Step. 11. Continue loosening in 1/8-turn increments until screws are loose. Remove head screws. 12. See Figure 3-9. Remove cylinder head (18), head gasket (4), and O-rings (14). NOTE Front cylinder must be removed through upper triangular frame members with front isolator mount attached. 13. See Figure 3-11. Remove both push rod covers (7) and hydraulic lifters (6). See 3.15 HYDRAULIC LIFTERS. 14. Repeat the above procedure for the other cylinder head.
2 4
3 1
b0390x3x
Figure 3-8. Front Isolator Mount (4th Tie Bar Not Shown)
3-13
HOME
xlhcylhead
7 8 5 1 7 8 5 6 11 9 16 2 17 18 10 17 4 16 5 6 11 9
10
14 15 3 19 12
20
13
8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. Upper Collar (2) Lower Collar (2) Valve (1 Intake, 1 Exhaust) Valve Stem Seal (2) Cylinder Stud (4) Base Gasket O-Ring (2) 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. Insert/Dowel (2) Valve Guide (2) Valve Seat (2) Cylinder Head Cylinder Piston
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
Head Screw, Long (2) Head Screw, Short (2) Arrow, Piston Direction Head Gasket Inner Valve Spring (2) Outer Valve Spring (2) Valve Keeper (4)
3-14
HOME
DISASSEMBLY
5
NOTE Disassembly of front cylinder exhaust valve components requires front isolator mount removal. 1. 2. See Figure 3-10. Compress valve springs with VALVE SPRING COMPRESSOR (Part No. HD-34736B). See Figure 3-9. Remove valve keepers (7), upper collar (8) and valve springs (5, 6). Mark valve keepers for reassembly in their original locations. Use a ne tooth le to remove any burrs on the valve stem at the keeper groove. Mark valve to ensure that it will be reassembled in the same head. Remove valve (10), valve stem seal (11) and lower collar (9). Repeat the above procedure for the other valve. Disassemble the other head using the same procedure.
7 3 1 8 10 6
3. 4.
5. 6.
11
5694
2
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. Right Crankcase Half Anti-Rotation Screws with Washers (2) Hydraulic Lifter (2) Push Rod Cover (2) Seal (2) Retainer (2) O-Ring (2) Screw (2) Push Rod (2) Washer (2) Locating Pin (2) Figure 3-11. Middle Valve Train Components (Quantities per Engine Cylinder)
2.
Measure and record rocker arm shaft bore diameter. a. b. In lower rocker cover. See Figure 3-14. Rocker arm bushing inner diameter. See Figure 315.
6.
3.
Check the measurements obtained in Steps 5-6 against the SERVICE WEAR LIMITS. Repair or replace parts exceeding limits. Assemble rocker arms and rocker arm shafts into lower rocker cover. Check end play of rocker arm with feeler gauge. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Engine 3-15
7. 8.
HOME
2767a 5699
Figure 3-14. Measuring Rocker Arm Shaft Bore Diameter in Lower Rocker Cover
Figure 3-12. Measuring Rocker Arm Shaft Diameter (Rocker Cover Position)
2768a
Figure 3-15. Measuring Rocker Arm Bushing Inner Diameter 12. Clean valve guides by lightly honing with VALVE GUIDE HONE (Part No. HD-34723). 13. Scrub guides with VALVE GUIDE BRUSH (Part No. HD34751) and hot soapy water. Measure valve stem outer diameter and valve guide inner diameter. Check measurements against SERVICE WEAR LIMITS. 14. Inspect spark plug threads for damage. If threads in head are damaged, a special plug type insert can be installed using a 12 mm spark plug repair kit. 15. Inspect valve springs for broken or discolored coils.
b0323x3x
Figure 3-13. Measuring Rocker Arm Shaft Diameter (Rocker Arm Bushing Position)
9.
Replace rocker arm or lower cover or both if end play exceeds 0.025 in. (0.635 mm).
10. Valve heads should have a seating surface width of 0.040-0.062 in. (1.016-1.575 mm), and should be free of pit marks and burn spots. The color of carbon on exhaust valves should be black or dark brown. White or light buff carbon indicates excessive heat and burning. 11. Valve seats are also subject to wear, pitting, and burning. Resurface valve seats whenever valves are renished. 3-16 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Engine Figure 3-16. Checking Spring Free Length
HOME 16. See Figure 3-16. Check free length and compression force of each spring. Compare with SERVICE WEAR LIMITS. If spring length is shorter than specication or if spring compression force is below specication, replace spring. 17. Examine push rods, particularly the ball ends. Replace any rods that are bent, worn, discolored or broken. 18. See Figure 3-17. Check head gasket surface on head for atness. Machine or replace any head which exceeds SERVICE WEAR LIMIT of 0.006 in. (0.152 mm).
2411a
2. 3.
4.
5700
3-17
HOME
5692
1 2
1.
To remove shoulderless guides, press or tap guides toward combustion chamber using DRIVER HANDLE AND REMOVER (Part No. HD-34740). Clean and measure valve guide bore in head. Measure outer diameter of a new standard valve guide. The guide diameter should be 0.0020-0.0033 in. (0.0508-0.0838 mm). larger than bore in head. If it is not, select one of the following oversizes: +0.001 in. (+0.025 mm), +0.002 in. (+0.051 mm) or +0.003 in. (+0.076 mm) (intake and exhaust). See Figure 3-19. Install shoulderless guides using VALVE GUIDE INSTALLATION TOOL (2) (Part No. HD34731) and DRIVER HANDLE (1) (Part No. HD-34740). Press or drive guide until the tool touches the machined surface surrounding the guide. At this point, the correct guide height has been reached. Ream guides to nal size or within 0.0010 in. (0.0254 mm) of nal size using VALVE GUIDE REAMER (Steel, Part No. HD-39932 or Carbide, Part No. HD39932-CAR). Use REAMER LUBRICANT (Part No. HD39964) or liberal amounts of suitable cutting oil to prevent reamer chatter. Apply the proper surface nish to the valve guide bores using the VALVE GUIDE HONE (Part No. HD-34723). Lubricate hone with honing oil. Driving hone with an electric drill, work for a crosshatch pattern with an angle of approximately 60. NOTE
2. 3.
1. 2. 3.
Driver Handle (Part No. HD-34740) Valve Guide Installation Tool (Part No. HD-34731) Cylinder Head Stand (Part No. HD-39782) Figure 3-19. Installing Shoulderless Valve Guide
5695
4.
5.
6.
1. 2.
Valve Guide Brush (Part No. HD-34751) Cylinder Head Holding Fixture (Part No. HD-39786) Figure 3-20. Cleaning Valve Guides
The hone is not intended to remove material. 7. See Figure 3-20. Thoroughly clean valve guide bores using VALVE GUIDE BRUSH (1) (Part No. HD-34751) and hot soapy water.
3-18
HOME
b0169x3x
Margin
2.
3.
4.
5.
6. 7.
3-19
HOME
5696
Lift valve and rotate it about 1/3 of a turn clockwise. Repeat lapping procedure in Step 1. Repeat Step 2. Then, remove valve. Wash valve face and seat. Dry parts with a new, clean cloth or towel. Inspect valve and seat. a. If inspection shows an unbroken lapped nish of uniform width around both valve and seat, valve is well seated. If lapped nish is not complete, further lapping (or grinding and lapping) is necessary.
5693
b.
1. 2.
Valve Lapping Tool (Part No. HD-96550-36A) Cylinder Head Holding Fixture (Part No. HD-39786) Figure 3-24. Lapping Valves
3-20
HOME
ASSEMBLY
CAUTION Make sure all lapping compound is removed from cylinder head and valves after lapping is completed. If lapping compound contaminates any internal engine components or engine oil, excessive engine wear and damage may result. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Wash cylinder head and valves in warm, soapy water to remove all lapping compound. Scrub valve guide bores with VALVE GUIDE BRUSH (Part No. HD-34751) and hot, soapy water. Blow dry with compressed air. Apply a liberal amount of engine oil to the valve stem. See Figure 3-25. Insert valve into valve guide (5) and install lower collar (4). See Figure 3-26. Place a protective sleeve over the valve stem keeper groove. Coat the sleeve with oil and place a new seal over the valve stem. CAUTION Always use a protective sleeve on the valve stem keeper groove when installing valve stem seal. If the seal is installed without using the protective sleeve, the seal will be damaged. CAUTION Do not remove valve after seal is installed. Otherwise, sharp edges on keeper groove will damage seal. 7. See Figure 3-25. Tap the valve stem seal (3) onto the valve guide (5) using the VALVE SEAL INSTALLATION TOOL (Part No. HD-34643A) and DRIVER HANDLE (Part No. HD-34740). The seal is completely installed when the tool touches the lower collar (4). See Figure 3-9. Install valve springs (5, 6) and upper collar (8). Compress springs with VALVE SPRING COMPRESSOR (Part No. HD-34736B).
13. If front isolator mount was removed, install as follows. a. Clean residual loctite from threads in engine with a suitable nonammable solvent and dry with compressed air. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 271 (red) to threads of new front isolator mount bolts. Apply a thin lm of clean HD 20W50 engine oil to both sides of new thick washers and to bottom of bolt heads. Exercise caution to avoid mixing oil on washers with loctite on bolts. Position front isolator mount and secure with two new front bolts with new thick washers. Tighten bolts to 60 ft-lbs (81 Nm) initially and then loosen each bolt one full turn. Tighten bolts again to 60 ftlbs (81 Nm).
b. c.
d.
b0172x3x
2 1
3 4 5
8. 9.
10. Insert valve keepers (7) into upper collar (8), making sure they engage groove in valve stem. The keeper gaps should be equal. 11. Release and remove VALVE SPRING COMPRESSOR. 12. Repeat Steps 4-11 for the remaining valve(s). 1. 2. Valve Seal Installation Tool Driver Handle 3. 4. 5. Valve Stem Seal Lower Collar Valve Guide
11 1WARNING WARNING
Always wear proper eye protection and gloves when working with compressed air. Debris or solvent may be blown out with enough force to penetrate skin or cause eye injury. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
3-21
HOME
5686
Protective Sleeve
CAUTION The procedure for tightening the head screws is critical to proper distribution of pressure over gasket area. It prevents gasket leaks, stud failure, and head and cylinder distortion. 10. See Figure 3-7. For each cylinder head, start with screw numbered one, as shown. In increasing numerical sequence (i.e. 1, 2, 3 and 4): a. b. c. Tighten each screw to 7-9 ft-lbs (10-12 Nm). Tighten each screw to 12-14 ft-lbs (16-19 Nm). Loosen all screws.
11. After screws are loosened from initial torque, tighten head screws in three stages. Tighten fasteners in increasing numerical sequence (i.e. 1, 2, 3 and 4). a. b. c. Tighten each screw to 7-9 ft-lbs (10-12 Nm). Tighten each screw to 12-14 ft-lbs (16-19 Nm). See Figure 3-27. Mark cylinder head and head screw shoulder with a line as shown (View A). Tighten each screw a 1/4-turn (90) (View B).
INSTALLATION
If only cylinder head work was needed, reinstall cylinder head following these instructions. If further repair is required, see 3.6 CYLINDER AND PISTON. 1. 2. See Figure 3-9. Coat mating surfaces of cylinder studs (12) and head screws (1, 2) with parts cleaning solution. Scrape old oil and any carbon deposits from threads by using a back-and-forth motion, threading each head screw onto its mating cylinder stud. Remove head screws from studs. Wipe or blow dry thread surfaces. Apply oil to stud threads and to the underside of the head screw shoulder. CAUTION Only oil lm must remain on the head screw surfaces. Too much oil will pool in the head screw sleeve. Pooled oil may prevent proper torque application and full thread engagement. 5. 6. 7. Blow or wipe off excess oil from head screws. Thoroughly clean and dry the gasket surfaces of cylinder (19) and cylinder head (18). Install a new O-ring (14) on each dowel (15). NOTE O-rings (14) help to properly position the head gasket (4). Orings must be installed before the head gasket. 8. 9. Install a new head gasket (4) to cylinder. Carefully lower cylinder head over studs and position on dowels. Use great care so as not to disturb head gasket.
b0094x3x
View A
View B
3. 4.
Tighten head screws 1/4-turn in the third stage of installation Figure 3-27. Tightening Head Screws 12. See Figure 3-11. Rotate engine so that both lifters (6), from the cylinder being serviced, will be installed on the base circle (lowest position) of the cam. 13. Apply a liberal amount of engine oil to lifter assembly (especially roller needles) for smooth initial operation. 14. Insert lifter (6) into bore in crankcase (1). Rotate lifter so that ats at upper end of lifter face the front and rear of the engine. If the lifter is installed incorrectly, pins (2) cannot be inserted. 15. Secure lifters in place. a. b. c. Insert pins (2) in the holes in crankcase. Place new O-rings (3) over ends of pins. Install plate (4) using screw (5) with washer (14). Tighten to 80-110 in-lbs (9-12 Nm).
3-22
HOME 16. Install push rod covers. a. b. c. Slide new seal (8) and retainer (9) over top of push rod cover (7). Position new O-ring (10) at top of push rod cover. Hold cover at an angle and insert top through hole in cylinder head. Push up on cover while aligning bottom of cover with lifter bore in crankcase. Lower retainer (9) with seal (8) onto crankcase, aligning locating pin (15) with hole in retainer. Insert screw (11) with washer (13) through hole in retainer (9). Thread screw (11) into tapped hole in crankcase. Tighten to 15-18 ft-lbs (20-24 Nm). 20. See Figure 3-5. Install middle and upper rocker covers. a. b. c. d. Place a new gasket (7) on lower rocker box assembly. Install middle rocker cover (5) with umbrella valve next to intake manifold. Place a new gasket (6) on middle rocker cover. Install upper rocker cover (4) using screws with washers (1) and new ber seals (2). Tighten screws to 10-14 ft-lbs (14-19 Nm).
d. e.
NOTE Intake push rods and valves are located next to the carburetors intake manifold; exhaust push rods and valves are next to the exhaust headers. 17. Identify push rod color coding, length and respective push rod positions in engine. See Table 3-5. Place intake and exhaust push rods onto seat at top of lifter.
6163
14 12 15 13 15 13 12 15 14
17897-89
ITEM NUMBER IN FIGURE 3-5. Bolt with washer (12) Bolt with washer (13) Screw with washer (14) Bolt with washer (15)
SIZE
TORQUE
18. See Figure 3-5. Install new gaskets (16, 17) with the bead facing up. Place lower rocker box assembly (with rocker arms and shafts) into position. Place push rods in rocker arm sockets. CAUTION Do not turn engine over until both push rods can be turned with ngers. Otherwise, damage to push rods or rocker arms may result. 19. See Figure 3-28. Install fasteners (12, 13, 14 and 15). Slowly snug all fasteners in small increments (one turn at a time). Use a cross pattern on the four large bolts (12, 13) that fasten the lower rocker box to head. This will bleed the lifters. a. b. c. Tighten bolts (12, 13) to 15-19 ft-lbs (20-26 Nm). Tighten bolts (15) to 10-14 ft-lbs (14-19 Nm). Tighten screws (14) to 130-150 in-lbs (15-17 Nm).
5/16-18 X 2-3/4 15-19 ft-lbs (20-26 Nm) 5/16-18 X 2-1/2 130-150 in-lbs (15-17 Nm) 10-14 ft-lbs (14-19 Nm)
1/4-20 X 1-1/2
1/4-20 X 1-1/4
NOTES Tubular frame prohibits direct access to bolt (12) on right rear cylinder. Use TORQUE ADAPTOR (SNAP-ON Part No. FRDH 181) and TORQUE COMPUTER (SNAP-ON Part No. SS-306G) to correctly assemble.
3-23
HOME
3.6
4. 5.
7 7 8
10 9
4 5
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Cylinder Dowel (2) and O-Ring (2) Piston Cylinder Stud (4) Base Gasket 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. Ring Set Retaining Ring (2) Piston Pin Piston Pin Bushing Connecting Rod
11 1WARNING WARNING
The piston pin retaining rings are highly compressed in the ring groove and may y out with considerable force when pried out of the groove. Always wear safety glasses or goggles while removing or installing retaining rings. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
CAUTION The piston pin retaining rings must not be reused. Removal may weaken retaining rings and they may break or dislodge. Either occurrence may damage engine. 8. Insert an awl in the recessed area below the piston pin bore and pry out the piston pin retaining rings. To prevent the ring from ying out, place your thumb over the retaining ring. NOTE Since the piston pin is a loose t in the piston, the pin will easily slide out. The pins have tapered ends to help seat the round retaining rings. See Figure 3-30. 1203cc piston pins are stamped with a V-groove at one end.
3-24
HOME 9. Mark each pin boss with either an F or an R to indicate front or rear cylinder, respectively. See Figure 3-30. The arrow at the top of 1203cc pistons must always point toward the front of the engine. CAUTION Handle the piston with extreme care. The alloy used in these pistons is very hard. Any scratches, gouges or other marks in the piston could score the cylinder during engine operation and cause engine damage. 10. See Figure 3-29. Spread piston rings (6) outward until they clear grooves in piston (3) and lift off.
b0057a3x
V-Groove
2. 3. 4. 5.
b.
6. 7. 8.
Clean piston pin retaining ring grooves. Examine piston and cylinder for cracks, burnt spots, grooves and gouges. Check connecting rod for up and down play in lower bearings. When up and down play is detected, lower bearing should be retted. This requires removing and disassembling engine crankcase.
HOME
b0306x3x
NOTE Torque plates, properly tightened and installed with gaskets, simulate engine operating conditions. Measurements will vary as much as 0.001 in. (0.025 mm) without torque plates. 3. Take cylinder bore measurement in ring path, starting about 1/2 in. (12.7 mm) from top of cylinder, measuring from front to rear and then side to side. Record readings. Repeat measurement at center and then at bottom of ring path. Record readings. This process will determine if cylinder is out-of-round (or egged) and will also show any cylinder taper or bulge. See Table 3-6. If cylinder is not scuffed or scored and is within service limit, see FITTING CYLINDER TO PISTON on page 3-27.
4.
5.
NOTE If piston clearance exceeds service limit, cylinders should be rebored and/or honed to next standard oversize, and retted with the corresponding piston and rings. Do not t piston tighter than 0.0007 in. (0.0178 mm). See 3.1 SPECIFICATIONS. Figure 3-32. Measuring Cylinder Bore Using Torque Plates (Part No. HD-33446A)
3.5100
89.1540
3.5200
89.4080
3.5300
89.6620
3-26
HOME
Measuring Piston
2747a
Because of their complex shape, the pistons cannot be accurately measured with standard measuring instruments. The pistons have the typical elliptical shape when viewed from the top. However, they also are barrel-shaped when viewed from the side. This barrel shape is not symmetrical. Any damage to the piston will change its shape, which will lead to problems.
1 3 2
Dot 1. 2. 3. Top Compression Ring Install either side up Second Compression Ring Dot Toward Top Oil Control Rings Figure 3-33. Piston Rings
2.
3.507 in.
89.078 mm
3.517 in.
89.332 mm
3.527 in.
89.586 mm
NOTE The same piston may be used if cylinder bore was not changed, unless it is scuffed or grooved. However, replace rings and hone the cylinder walls with a No. 240 grit exible hone to facilitate ring seating. 2. See Figure 3-35. Apply engine oil to piston grooves. Use TRANSMISSION SHAFT RETAINING RING PLIERS (Part No. J-5586) to slip compression rings over piston into their respective grooves. Be extremely careful not to over expand, twist rings or damage piston surface when installing rings. NOTE Install second compression ring with dot towards top. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Engine 3-27
HOME
2784a
Transmission Shaft Retaining Ring Pliers (Part No. J-5586) Figure 3-35. Installing Piston Rings Figure 3-34. Measuring Ring End Gap 3. See Figure 3-36. Install rings so end gaps of adjacent rings are a minimum of 90 apart. Ring gaps are not to be within 10 of the thrust face centerline. See Figure 3-37. Check for proper side clearance with thickness gauge, as shown. See 3.1 SPECIFICATIONS for tolerance. Piston Pin
b0095x3x
4.
NOTE If the ring grooves are clean and the side play is still not correct, replace the rings, the piston or both.
2785a
3-28
HOME
2786a
NOTE If CONNECTING ROD CLAMPING TOOL holes are too small, enlarge the holes in the tool. 3. See Figure 3-39. Attach PISTON PIN BUSHING TOOL (Part No. HD-95970-32C) to the connecting rod. The receiver cup (1) ts on one side of the rod while the driver (2) ts on the opposite side as shown. Use two box wrenches and push worn bushing from connecting rod. Remove piston pin bushing tool from connecting rod. Remove bushing from receiver cup. Attach PISTON PIN BUSHING TOOL (Part No. HD95970-32C) to connecting rod. Place new bushing between connecting rod and driver. 1. 2. 3. Piston Pin Bushing Tool (Part No. HD-95970-32C) Rod Clamping Tool (Part No. HD-95952-33A) Plastic Hose Figure 3-38. Installing New Piston Pin Bushing
4. 5. 6. 7.
NOTE The driver must be attached facing the opposite direction as it was for removal of the bushing. 8. Clean up and size bushing to 0.0010-0.0005 in. (0.0254-0.0127 mm) undersize using REAMER (Part No. HD-94800-26A). Sizing bushing with less than 0.00125 in. (0.03175 mm) clearance can result in a bushing loosening and/or seized pin in rod. Hone bushing to nal size using WRIST PIN BUSHING HONE (Part No. HD-35102). Use a liberal amount of honing oil to prevent damage to hone or bushing. Use care to prevent foreign material from falling into the crankcase. CAUTION Replace bent connecting rods. Do not attempt to straighten. Straightening rods by bending will damage the bearing on the crank pin and the piston pin bushing. Installing bent connecting rods will damage cylinder and piston beyond repair.
b0173a3x
2 4 3
9.
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Figure 3-39. Piston Pin Bushing Tool Assembly for Bushing Removal
3-29
HOME
ASSEMBLY/INSTALLATION
1. 2. See Figure 3-40. Place PISTON SUPPORT PLATE (3) (Part No. HD-42322) around connecting rod. Install piston assembly over connecting rod. NOTE New 1203cc pistons must be installed with the arrow, at the top of the piston, pointing towards the front of the engine. 3. Install piston pin.
7070
11 1WARNING WARNING
The piston pin retaining rings are highly compressed in the ring groove and may y out with considerable force when pried out of the groove. Always wear safety glasses or goggles while removing or installing retaining rings. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. 1. 2. 3. 4.
4 3
Piston Pin Retaining Ring Piston Pin Retaining Ring Installer Piston Support Plate Plugged Lifter Bores Figure 3-40. Installing Piston Retaining Rings
CAUTION Always use new retaining ring. Make sure retaining ring groove is clean and that ring seats rmly in groove. If it does not, discard the ring. Never install a used retaining ring or a new one if it has been installed and then removed for any reason. A loosely installed ring will come out of the piston groove and damage cylinder and piston beyond repair. 4. See Figure 3-40. Install new piston pin retaining rings (1) using PISTON PIN RETAINING RING INSTALLER (2) (Part No. HD-34623B). Place new retaining ring on tool with gap pointing up. See Figure 3-41. NOTE Make sure the ring groove is clean. Ring must be fully seated in the groove with the gap away from the slot at the bottom. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. See Figure 3-36. Make sure the piston ring end gaps are properly positioned as shown. Remove PISTON SUPPORT PLATE. Lubricate cylinder wall, piston, pin and rod bushing with engine oil. Turn engine until piston is at top dead center. See Figure 3-42. Compress the piston rings using PISTON RING COMPRESSOR (Part No. HD-96333-51C).
3535c
b0382x3x
10. Remove protective sleeves from cylinder studs. Install a new cylinder base gasket. Make sure the piston does not bump the studs or crankcase. 11. Install cylinder over piston. 12. Remove PISTON RING COMPRESSOR. 13. Assemble cylinder head. See 3.5 CYLINDER HEAD. 14. Install cylinder head. See 3.5 CYLINDER HEAD. 15. Install assembled engine. See 3.4 INSTALLING THE ENGINE. 1. Piston Ring Compressor (Part No. HD-96333-51C) Figure 3-42. Compressing Piston Rings
3-30
3 HOME
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
CHECKING AND ADDING OIL
Check engine oil level in oil tank at least once every 500 miles (800 km). Check level more frequently if engine uses more oil than normal or if vehicle is operated under harsh conditions. Oil tank capacity with lter change is 2.0 quarts (1.89 liters).
3.7
WINTER LUBRICATION
Normal fuel combustion in a gasoline engine produces water vapor and carbon dioxide along with other gases and particulates. When rst starting and warming an engine, some of the water vapor that gets into the engine crankcase condenses to form liquid water. If the engine is driven long enough to thoroughly warm the crankcase, most of this liquid water is again vaporized and exhausted through the crankcase breather system. A moderately driven vehicle making short runs may not be able to vacate water vapors allowing liquid water to accumulate in the oil tank. This is especially true if the vehicle is operated in cold weather. In freezing weather, an accumulation of water in the engine oil may become slush or ice, which can block oil lines and lead to severe engine damage. Water remaining in the engine oil for long periods of time can form an acidic sludge that is corrosive to metal engine parts and causes accelerated wear of moving components. In winter the oil change interval should be shorter than normal. The colder the weather, the shorter the recommended oil change interval. A vehicle used only for short runs in cold weather must have the engine oil drained frequently.
3-31
HOME
3.8
2 1 3 4
1. 2. 3.
4.
b0248a3x
4 3
b0344x3x
1 5 1 2
1. 2. 3. Feed Hose Drain Hose Vent Hose 4. 5. Return Hose T-Fitting 1. 2. 3. 4. Vent Hose Clamp Elbow Fitting Gearcase Cover Figure 3-45. Vent Hose Connection (Typical)
2 3 4
3-32
HOME
OIL TANK
REMOVAL/DISASSEMBLY
1. 2. 3. Remove seat, fuel tank and tail section. See 2.33 TAIL SECTION. Remove rear fender. See 2.32 REAR FENDER. Drain oil tank. See 1.4 ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM. The oil lter need not be removed unless it is due to be replaced. See Figure 3-46. Remove clamps to detach hoses from oil tank. Label each hose upon removal. a. b. c. d. 5. 6. Remove feed hose worm clamp (3) from T-tting. Remove 3/8 in. drain hose clamp (5) from T-tting. Remove 1/4 in. clamp (8) from vent hose (7). Remove 3/8 in. clamp (10) from return hose (9). T-Fitting on Tank
b0247a3x
3.9
10 9 8
4.
1 2 6 3 5
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10.
Remove four bolts and lockwashers from wellnuts (1). Detach oil tank from frame.
ASSEMBLY/INSTALLATION
1. See Figure 3-46. Place oil tank on frame and align mounts. Loosely install bolts and lockwashers (1) at all four mounting points.
NOTE Starting at the top mounting points will simplify installation. 2. Connect the four oil tank hoses. Tighten new clamps (5, 8 and 10) using HOSE CLAMP PLIERS (Part No. HD41137).
NOTE Worm clamp (3) may be reused on feed hose (4). 3. 4. Fill oil tank. See 1.4 ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM. Install rear fender. See 2.32 REAR FENDER.
Bolt, Lockwasher and Wellnut (4) Oil Tank Worm Clamp, 3/8 in. Feed Hose Hose Clamp, 3/8 in. Drain Hose Vent Hose Hose Clamp, 1/4 in. Return Hose Hose Clamp, 3/8 in. Figure 3-46. Oil Tank
11 1WARNING WARNING
After installing seat, pull upward on front of seat to be sure it is locked in position. If seat is loose, it could shift during vehicle operation and startle the rider, which could result in death or serious injury. 5. Install tail section, fuel tank and seat. See 2.33 TAIL SECTION.
3-33
HOME
3.10
Ignition switch is turned on prior to starting engine. Oil is not circulating through the running engine. Oil pressure is abnormally low on the running engine. Engine is idling far below 1000 RPM.
6218
b0350x3x
Oil is circulating with adequate pressure through the engine running at 1000 RPM or greater.
Oil Filter
Troubleshooting information is listed in Table 3-8. NOTE If the ignition is turned back on immediately after the engine is stopped, the oil light may not turn on right away because of oil pressure retained in the lter housing. Switch
OIL PRESSURE
See Figure 3-47. The oil pump is nonregulatory and delivers its entire volume of oil under pressure to the oil lter mount. When an engine is cold, the engine oil will be more viscous (i.e., thicker). During start-up of a cold engine, oil pressure will be higher than normal and oil circulation will be somewhat restricted within the oiling system. As the engine warms to normal operating temperature, the engine oil will warm up and become less viscous oil pressure decreases. When an engine is operated at high speeds, the volume of oil circulated through the oiling system increases, resulting in higher oil pressure. As engine speed is reduced, the volume of oil pumped is also reduced, resulting in lower oil pressure. To check oil pressure, use OIL PRESSURE GAUGE (Part No. HD-96921-52A) and OIL PRESSURE GAUGE ADAPTER (Part No. HD-96940-52A). Remove oil pressure indicator switch and insert pressure gauge tting. See Figure 3-48. Ride motorcycle at least 20 miles (32 km) at or above 50 MPH (80 KM/H) until engine oil reaches normal operating temperature. At 2500 RPM, oil pressure will vary from 10-17 psi (69-117 kN/m2). At idle speed (950-1050 RPM), oil pressure will vary from 7-12 psi (48-83 kN/m2).
PROBABLE CAUSES Empty oil tank. Clogged feed line (ice and sludge, freezing temperatures). Air-bound oil line. Grounded oil switch wire. Malfunctioning signal switch. Diluted oil. Malfunctioning check valve (see 3.14 OIL FILTER MOUNT). Incorrect idle speed. Malfunctioning or improperly installed check valve (see 3.14 OIL FILTER MOUNT). Malfunctioning signal switch. Malfunction in wiring. Burned-out signal bulb. Dead battery (see NOTE above).
Flickers at idle.
G G G G
3-34
HOME
3.11
1 3
2 4
1. 2. 3. 4. Push Rod Cover (2) Oil Drain Hole Umbrella Valve Breather Bolt Figure 3-49. Crankcase Breathing System, Typical Cylinder
3-35
HOME
3.12
10. Oil enters a hole in the end of the pinion gear shaft and travels to the right ywheel where it is routed through the ywheel to the crankpin. Oil is forced through the crankpin to properly lubricate the rod bearing assembly. 11. Oil ows up passages in the push rods to the rocker arm shafts and bushings. 12. The valve stems are lubricated by oil supplied through drilled oil holes in the rocker arms. 13. Oil collected in the push rod areas of the cylinder heads ows down the push rod covers, through drain holes in the lifter blocks and into the gearcase. 14. Feed oil to the rocker area is returned to the crankcase through a passage in the head and cylinder. 15. Oil collected in the sump is splash-fed to the pistons, cylinder walls and ywheel components. 16. Oil collected in the sump area returns to the scavenge section of the oil pump through a passage located in the rear section of the sump. Oil ow to the pump is accomplished by the scavenging effect of the pump and by the pressure created by the downward stroke of the pistons. 17. Return oil lls a cavity above the pump's return gears. The return gears pump oil back to the oil tank. 18. A small amount of oil ows from the feed galley in the right crankcase half through a restricted orice, which sprays the oil onto the rear intake cam gear in the gearcase. Oil is transferred to the teeth of all the cam gears through the gear meshing action.
NOTE See 3.13 OIL PUMP for a complete explanation of the gerotor pump sets. 2. 3. 4. The feed pump transfers oil from the inlet cavity through the feed hose to the oil lter mount. Oil ows through the lter mount cavity to the oil lter. Oil enters the peripheral cavity of the oil lter, passes through the ltering medium into the central cavity of the oil lter, and ows into the lter adapter (tting which connects lter to lter mount). Adequate oil pressure in the lter mount cavity activates the oil pressure signal light switch and shuts off the oil pressure signal light. Oil owing from the lter adapter opens the check ball. The check ball opens at 4-6 psi (28-41 kN/m2) oil pressure. With the check ball open, oil ows into the crankcase feed galley. Oil ows through the feed galley in the crankcase to the lifter blocks and hydraulic lifters. Cross-drilled passages intersect the main feed galley and carry oil to each hydraulic lifter. Oil also enters an intersecting passage in the gearcase cover. Oil ow is then routed to the crankshaft area.
5.
6.
7. 8.
9.
3-36
HOME
HOME
OIL PUMP
MODEL YEAR CHANGE
All 2001 Buell Air Twin Models have a new oil pump with a modied casting that allows for better scavenging. All wear limits and specications remain the same as previous years. 2.
3.13
of the missing tooth. The gradually enlarging cavity creates a vacuum into which oil ows from the inlet. During the next 180 of rotation, the size of the cavity decreases forcing oil into the outlet.
GENERAL
See Figure 3-50. The oil pump consists of two gerotor gear sets, feed and scavenge (return), housed in one pump body. The feed set distributes oil to the engine, the scavenge set returns oil to the tank. The pump body features split kidney scavenge ports. A gerotor-type gear set has two parts an inner and an outer gerotor. The inner gerotor has one less tooth than the outer gerotor. Both gerotors have xed centers which are offset to each other. In a gerotor gear set, oil is transferred from inlet to outlet as it is trapped between the rotating inner and outer gerotors. The illustration below shows the principle of gerotor operation: 1. During the rst 180 of rotation, the cavity between inner and outer gerotors gradually increases in size until it reaches its maximum size, equivalent to the full volume
See Figure 3-52. Gravity-fed oil from the oil tank enters the pump through the feed hose connector (5). It is forced by the gerotor feed set (7) through a hose to the oil lter. Return oil from the ywheel compartment is drawn back into the pump and is forced by the gerotor scavenge set (9) back to the oil tank. See INTERNAL ENGINE PASSAGES for oil passages within the engine. The oil pump seldom needs servicing. Before you disassemble an oil pump suspected of not producing adequate oil pressure, be absolutely certain that all possible related malfunctions have been eliminated: 1. 2. Make sure all oil hose clamps are tight and that hoses are not pinched or damaged. Check oil level and condition of oil in tank. Pressure will be affected if oil is diluted. In freezing weather, proper circulation of oil can be affected if the oil feed hose becomes clogged with ice and sludge. Check for a grounded oil pressure switch wire or faulty switch if oil indicator light fails to go out with engine running.
3.
b0098x3x
Inner Gerotor
Outer Gerotor
Oil drawn into cavity between gerotor teeth Oil Inlet Oil Outlet Oil trapped between gerotor teeth
Oil Inlet
Oil Outlet
3
Figure 3-50. Principle of Gerotor Operation
Oil Outlet
3-37
HOME
REMOVAL/DISASSEMBLY
NOTE Oil pump can be removed with engine in frame and without removing gearcase cover. 1. 2. 3. Drain oil tank. See 1.4 ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM. See Figure 3-51. Disconnect feed hose (3). Remove clamp (6) from lter hose. Detach oil lter hose connection (5).
b0055x3x
10 9 11 12 7 8
NOTE Loosen nut on oil lter hose connection (5) and then remove pressurized hose. 4. Carefully remove mounting screws and washers (1). Pump will drop with screws removed. Discard mounting gasket. Remove clamp and detach return hose connection (4). See Figure 3-52. Remove T27 TORX cover screws (2) and washers (3). Lift cover (6) off body (12). Remove and discard O-ring (14). Slide both pieces of gerotor feed set (7), separator plate (8) and both pieces of gerotor scavenge set (9) off gear shaft (11). Remove and discard retaining ring (16). Remove thrust washer (15) and gear shaft (11).
5. 6.
14
7.
5 3 4 2
8.
13 15 16
5709
1 3 6 5 4
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. Mounting Screw (2) (Long) Cover Screw (2) (Short) Washer (4) Oil Filter Mount Connector Feed Hose Connector Cover Gerotor Feed Set Gerotor Separator Plate Gerotor Scavenge Set Mounting Gasket Gear Shaft Body Return Hose Elbow Connector O-Ring Thrust Washer Retaining Ring Figure 3-52. Oil Pump
1
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
Mounting Screw and Washer (2) (long) Cover Screw and Washer (2) (short) Feed Hose Connection Return Hose Connection Oil Filter Hose Connection Clamp Figure 3-51. Oil Pump Hardware
3-38
HOME
Inner Gerotor
d.
3.
Check gear shaft (11) teeth for damage or wear. Replace if necessary.
6620
ASSEMBLY/INSTALLATION
NOTE Liberally coat all moving parts with clean engine oil to ensure easy assembly and smooth operation at start-up. 1. See Figure 3-52. Install gear shaft (11) through body (12). Position thrust washer (15) over end of shaft. Install new retaining ring (16) into groove in shaft. Insert inner gerotor of the gerotor scavenge set (9) over gear shaft. Place outer gerotor over inner to complete scavenge set (9). See Figure 3-54. Position gerotor separator plate into case and line up slots on perimeter with tabs inside oil pump body. Place gerotor feed set (7) over gear shaft (11). Install a new O-ring (14) into groove in cover (6). Place cover onto pump body. Install T27 TORX cover screws (2) with washers (3). Tighten to 125-150 in-lbs (1417 Nm). Place new mounting gasket (10) in position. NOTE Use new hose clamps. If ttings were removed, use TEFLON PIPE SEALANT or HYLOMAR on tting threads. 8. 9. See Figure 3-51. Attach return hose connection (4). Secure pump to crankcase with mounting screws (1) and washers. Tighten to 125-150 in-lbs (14-17 Nm).
1 4
3 2
2. 3. 4.
5. 6.
1. 2. 3. 4.
Gerotor Separator Plate Slot on Separator Plate Tab on Oil Pump Body O-Ring Figure 3-54. Separator Plate Slots
7.
10. Attach feed hose (3) and oil lter hose connection (5). 11. Attach clamp (6) and canister to hose. 12. Prime oil pump. Loosen feed hose connection and start engine. Operate at idle and allow about 2.0 ounces (0.06 liter) of engine oil to be forced through hose connection. Stop engine and tighten hose connection. 13. Check engine oil level. Add oil to correct level if needed. See 1.4 ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM.
3-39
HOME
3.14
4 3 2 1
DISASSEMBLY
1. 2. 3. Drain oil tank and remove lter. See 1.4 ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM. Remove lter adapter (1) from lter mount (4). Remove check ball (2) and spring (3). Detach indicator lamp wire (7) from oil pressure indicator switch (6). Remove switch using OIL PRESSURE SENDING UNIT WRENCH (Part No. HD-41675). 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
CLEANING/INSPECTION
Thoroughly clean all parts in cleaning solvent. Blow out holes and passages using compressed air.
ASSEMBLY
NOTE Use TEFLON PIPE SEALANT or HYLOMAR on all ttings installed to oil lter mount. 1. Install oil pressure indicator switch (6) using OIL PRESSURE SENDING UNIT WRENCH (Part No. HD-41675). Tighten to 5-7 ft-lbs (7-10 Nm).
Filter Adapter Check Ball Spring Filter Mount (part of Right Crankcase Half) Hose from Oil Pump Oil Pressure Indicator Switch Indicator Lamp Wire Figure 3-55. Oil Filter Mount
3.
Install lter mount components. a. b. c. Place spring (3) and check ball (2) into threaded hole at center of mount (4). Push threaded end of lter adapter (with LOCTITE) (1) against check ball to compress spring. Screw adapter into threaded hole. Tighten to 8-12 ftlbs (11-16 Nm).
NOTE The lter adapter (1) has identical ends; either end may be installed into the lter mount (4). 2. Apply LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 243 (blue) to the threads on that end of the lter adapter (1) which is installed into lter mount (4). Do not apply LOCTITE to adapter threads on lter element side.
4. 5.
Attach indicator lamp wire (7). Install a new lter and ll oil tank with proper oil. See 1.4 ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM.
3-40
HOME
HYDRAULIC LIFTERS
GENERAL
See Figure 3-56. The hydraulic lifter assembly consists of a lifter and roller. The lifter and roller, under compression force from valve spring, follow the surface of the revolving cam. The up-and-down motion produced is transmitted to the valve by the push rod and rocker arm. The lifter contains a piston (or plunger) and cylinder; it also contains a check valve, which allows the unit to ll with engine oil, thereby reducing clearance in the valve train. When a lifter is functioning properly, the assembly operates with minimal clearance. The unit automatically compensates for heat expansion to maintain a no-clearance condition. It is normal for lifters to click when engine is started after standing for some time. Lifters have a denite leakdown rate which permits the oil in the lifters to escape. This is necessary to allow units to compensate for various expansion conditions of parts and still maintain correct clearance operation. Lifters are functioning properly if they become quiet after a few minutes of engine operation.
b0174x3x
3.15
Piston
Oil Oil
Check Valve
Roller
REMOVAL
1. 2. Clean all dirt from around crankcase. Blow loose particles from area with compressed air. Remove the upper, middle, and lower rocker covers. See 3.5 CYLINDER HEAD. Pull each push rod upward through top of cylinder head. See Figure 3-58. Remove both push rod covers (4). a. b. c. 4. Remove screw (8) and washer (10). Lift retainer (6) and seal (7) upward a few inches on push rod cover (4). Push upward on push rod cover while pulling bottom of cover clear of crankcase. Remove cover. Remove two anti-rotation screws with washers (2). Remove lifters (3) from crankcase bore using a thinbladed screwdriver. Mark the location and orientation (front/back) of each lifter. 4. 3. b. Figure 3-56. Lifter Assembly (Typical) 2. Inspect hydraulic lifters for excessive clearance in guide. Accurately measure lifter bore inner diameter with a gauge. a. Clearance should be within 0.0008-0.0020 in. (0.0203-0.0508 mm). Fit a new lifter and/or replace crankcases if clearance exceeds SERVICE WEAR LIMIT of 0.0030 in. (0.076 mm).
3.
Check lifter roller freeplay. a. Roller clearance on pin should be within 0.00060.0010 in. (0.0152-0.0254 mm). Replace lifters if clearance exceeds SERVICE WEAR LIMIT of 0.0015 in. (0.0381 mm).
b.
CLEANING/INSPECTION
1. Clean all parts, except roller/lifter assembly, thoroughly in solvent. Blow dry with compressed air.
Check lifter roller end clearance. a. End clearance should be within 0.008-0.022 in. (0.203-0.559 mm). Replace lifters if clearance exceeds SERVICE WEAR LIMIT of 0.026 in. (0.660 mm).
b.
NOTE Inside and outside micrometers used for measuring lifters and lifter guides must be calibrated to ensure accurate readings.
5.
3-41
HOME
INSTALLATION
1. See Figure 3-57. Rotate engine so that both lifters, from the cylinder being serviced, will be installed on the base circle (1) of the cam.
b0134a3x
b0509a3x
151
3
151
1
151
8 10 6
Figure 3-57. Base Circle 2. Apply a liberal amount of engine oil to each lifter assembly (especially the roller needles) for smooth initial operation. See Figure 3-58. Insert lifter (3) into bore in crankcase (1) with lifter oil hole facing towards the oil trough. Rotate lifter so that ats at upper end of lifter faces the front and rear of the engine. If the lifter is installed incorrectly, antirotation screws (2) cannot be inserted. Secure lifters in place. a. b. 5. Insert anti-rotation screws with washers (2) in the threaded holes in crankcase. Tighten anti-rotation screws to 80-110 in-lbs (9-12 Nm)
11
3.
2
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. Right Crankcase Half Anti-Rotation Screws with Washers (2) Hydraulic Lifter (2) Push Rod Cover (2) Seal (2) Retainer (2) O-Ring (2) Screw (2) Push Rod (2) Washer (2) Locating Pin (2) Figure 3-58. Hydraulic Lifter Service
4.
Install push rod covers. a. b. c. Slide new seal (5) and retainer (6) over top of push rod cover (4). Position new O-ring (7) at top of push rod cover. Hold cover at an angle and insert top through hole in cylinder head. Push up on cover while aligning bottom of cover with lifter bore in crankcase. Lower retainer (6) with seal (5) onto crankcase, aligning locating pin (11) with hole in retainer. Insert screw (8) with washer (10) through hole in retainer (6). Thread screw (8) into tapped hole in crankcase. Tighten to 15-18 ft-lbs (20-24 Nm).
d. e.
6.
Install push rods and rocker covers. See 3.5 CYLINDER HEAD.
3-42
HOME
3.16
GENERAL
Read the complete gearcase section carefully before you begin any service work. For the gearcase components to operate at their optimum, all components must be properly tted and matched. Changing one component can affect many others. It is important to know and understand all inspection procedures and how components interact.
b0058a3x
13 10 13 3 4 8
12 5 9 13 17 2 11 13 1 14 6 15 16
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
Rear Exhaust Cam Gear Rear Intake Cam Gear Front Intake Cam Gear Front Exhaust Cam Gear Pinion Gear Seal
7. 8.
Front Intake Cam Gear Bushing Front Exhaust Cam Gear Bushing 9. Gearcase Cover Gasket 10. Right Crankcase Half 11. Nut 12. Oil Pump Drive Gear
13. Cam Gear Bushing (4) 14. Rear Exhaust Cam Gear Bushing 15. Rear Intake Cam Gear Bushing 16. Pinion Shaft Bushing 17. Gearcase Cover
Figure 3-59. Gearcase and Valve Train Components 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Engine 3-43
HOME
REMOVAL/DISASSEMBLY
1. See Figure 3-59. Thoroughly clean area around gearcase cover (17) and lifters. Blow loose dirt from crankcase with compressed air. Remove any parts that will interfere with gearcase disassembly (i.e., exhaust header, air cleaner, etc.). Remove push rods. See 3.5 CYLINDER HEAD. Remove hydraulic lifters. See 3.15 HYDRAULIC LIFTERS. Check for minimum cam gear end play. Record readings. Remove cam position sensor and rotor from gearcase cover. See 4.30 CAM POSITION SENSOR AND ROTOR. Place a pan under gearcase to collect oil. Remove cover screws. Carefully remove gearcase cover. Discard old gasket (9).
b0096a3x
Identify cams by stamped number 15-1 = Rear Exhaust 15-2 = Rear Intake 15-3 = Front Intake 15-4 = Front Exhaust
2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
7.
NOTE If cover does not come loose on removal of screws, tap lightly with a plastic hammer. Never pry cover off. 8. Remove cam gears (1, 2, 3 and 4). Carefully mark each component to ensure correct installation.
NOTE Nut (11) is secured by LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 262 (red) on the nut threads. 9. Remove nut (11). Slide pinion gear (5) and oil pump drive gear (12) off pinion shaft.
2806a
2. 3.
2.
3-44
HOME
b0806x3x
2 1
5
1. 2. 3. Rear Exhaust Cam Gear (15-1) Rear Intake Cam Gear (15-2) Front Intake Cam Gear (15-3) 4. 5. NOTE Front Exhaust Cam Gear (15-4) Though not depicted, Rear Intake Cam Pinion Gear Gear has 46 teeth and Pinion Gear has 23 teeth.
Bushing Installation
NOTE Installing and reaming crankcase and gearcase cover bushings may alter the center distances between mating gears and may result in an increase in gear noise. For quiet-running gears, the gears should be matched to the center distances.
2.
After you install a new bushing in gearcase cover, lineream the bushing to correct size. See BUSHING REAMING.
2.
2.
3.
3-45
HOME
b0089x3x
2.
1. 2.
3.
4.
3319a
Bushing Reaming
NOTE
G
Installing and reaming crankcase and gearcase cover bushings may alter the center distances between mating gears and may result in an increase in gear noise. For quiet-running gears, the gears should be matched to the center distances. Bushings in right crankcase half serve as pilots for reaming gearcase cover bushings and must, therefore, be reamed to size rst. After reaming any bushing, check shaft t in the bushing. It may be necessary to make a second pass with reamer to attain proper t.
1. 2.
3.
xlh0355
4. Figure 3-63. Rear Intake Cam Gear Bushing Installed in Gearcase Cover 5.
3-46
HOME
6.
Thoroughly clean gearcase cover, removing all metal chips/shavings. Blow out all oil passages using compressed air.
3534a
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
2.
2.
3.
4.
3.
5.
4.
HOME 5. Remove pilot from right crankcase roller race. Thoroughly clean gearcase cover, removing all metal chips/ shavings. Blow out all oil passages using compressed air.
3545a
ASSEMBLY/INSTALLATION
1. See Figure 3-68. Install oil pump drive gear (5) and pinion gear on pinion shaft. a. b. c. 2. Slide oil pump gear drive gear (5) over pinion shaft (1). Drive gear must align with shaft key (4). Align keyway (3) in ID of pinion gear with shaft key (4). Slide pinion gear over shaft key (4) and against oil pump drive gear (5). Clean threads on pinion shaft and nut. See Figure 3-69. Install CRANKSHAFT LOCKING TOOL (Part No. HD-43984) to gearcase with Side A facing out, over pinion shaft, with two screws. Apply several drops of LOCTITE THREADLOCKER 262 (red) to threads of nut. Install nut to pinion shaft. Tighten nut to 35-45 ft-lbs (48-61 Nm). 1. 2. Pilot (Part No. HD-94812-87) Reamer (Part No. HD-94812-1) Figure 3-67. Line Reaming Pinion Shaft Bushing
c. d. 3.
b0342x3x
1 2
Liberally apply engine oil to bushings, shafts, and gears. Install all cam gears into bushings of right crankcase half, properly aligning timing marks of cam gears and pinion gear. See Figure 3-62.
NOTE Because of the larger diameter additional gear (which meshes with the pinion gear) on the outboard end of the rear intake (15-2) cam gear, the rear exhaust (15-1) and front intake (15-3) cam gears must both be installed before the rear intake (15-2) cam gear is installed. CAUTION Use only the correct gearcase cover gasket (see parts catalog for Part No.). Using pre-2000 model year gasket will obstruct oil galley and result in engine damage. 4. See Figure 3-59. Install a new seal (6) and new dry gearcover gasket (9) on gearcase cover (17). 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
3 4 5
Pinion Shaft Timing Mark on Pinion Gear Keyway Shaft Key Oil Pump Drive Gear Figure 3-68. Aligning Pinion Gear
3-48
HOME 5. Install gearcase cover over all gears and onto right crankcase half (10). Secure cover to crankcase half with 11 socket head screws. Tighten screws evenly to 80-110 in-lbs (9-12 Nm). Use torque sequence shown in Figure 3-70. See Figure 3-71. Check cam gear end play for each cam gear as follows: a. Turn engine over until lobe of cam gear being checked is pointing toward its respective lifter guide hole. Gently pry the cam gear toward the gearcase cover using a at blade screwdriver. Measure gap between bushing (in crankcase half) and cam gear shaft thrust face (shoulder) using a feeler gauge. This is cam gear end play. Compare cam gear end play measurements with the SERVICE WEAR LIMITS. Make repairs as required if end play does not meet specications.
b0064a3x
8 3 7 1 9 10 11 6 4 2 5
Figure 3-70. Gearcase Cover Mounting Screw Torque Sequence
6.
b. c.
d.
7. 8. 9.
Install hydraulic lifters and push rods. See 3.15 HYDRAULIC LIFTERS. Install cam position sensor and rotor in gearcase cover. See 4.30 CAM POSITION SENSOR AND ROTOR. Install any components removed to gain access to gearcase (i.e. exhaust system components, air cleaner, etc.).
7988
b0337a3x
3-49
HOME
CRANKCASE
GENERAL
CAUTION If engine is removed from chassis, do not lay engine on primary side. Placing engine on primary side will damage clutch cable end tting. If tting is damaged, clutch cable must be replaced. Remove engine from chassis to repair rod bearings, pinion shaft bearing or sprocket shaft bearing. See 3.3 STRIPPING MOTORCYCLE FOR ENGINE REPAIR. It is recommended procedure to overhaul engine if removed. This includes inspecting and repairing cylinder heads, cylinders, gearcase and transmission.
b0292x3x
3.17
ADJUSTMENT/TESTING
Figure 3-72. Checking Flywheel End Play
5.
NOTE Use a thinner shim for less end play; use a thicker shim for more end play.
3-50
HOME
DISASSEMBLY
Crankcase Halves
1. Remove cylinder heads. See 3.5 CYLINDER HEAD.
4. 5.
Remove gearcase components. See 3.16 GEARCASE COVER AND CAM GEARS. Remove primary cover and primary drive/clutch components. See Primary Chain/Drive under 6.5 PRIMARY DRIVE/CLUTCH. Remove starter motor. See 5.7 STARTER. Remove transmission. See 6.7 TRANSMISSION CASE. See Figure 3-73. Remove screws and rear engine mount bolt securing crankcase halves together. Position crankcase on work bench, gearcase side up. Tap crankcase with plastic mallet to loosen top half and separate the halves.
6. CAUTION After removing cylinders, install plastic or rubber hose over cylinder studs. Lifting or moving crankcase by grasping studs will cause cylinder stud damage. 2. 3. Remove cylinders and pistons. See 3.6 CYLINDER AND PISTON. Remove oil pump. See 3.13 OIL PUMP. 7. 8. 9.
b0516x3x
2 2
3 2 4
1. 2. 3. 4. Crankcase Upper Case Hex Socket Head Screw 5/16-18 X 2-1/2 in. (4) Bottom Case T40 TORX Bolt 5/16-18 X 3/4 in. (4) Mufer Mount Bolt 3/8-16 X 5-1/2 in. (2, with Washers and Locknuts) Figure 3-73. Crankcase Hardware (Typical)
3-51
HOME
11 1WARNING WARNING
The next step requires using a press. Wear eye protection and make certain set-up is stable. The pressure involved could cause parts to y out with considerable force. Inadequate safety precautions could result in death or serious injury. 10. See Figure 3-74. Mount the left crankcase half and ywheel assembly on a press table, supporting crankcase on parallel bars. Press on end of sprocket shaft with arbor press until ywheel assembly is free from crankcase half. Do not drive ywheel assembly from crankcase half as ywheels may be knocked out of alignment. NOTE See Figure 3-74. If it is necessary to remove either the pinion shaft bearing (11) or sprocket shaft bearing (4 and 9), proceed as follows: 11. Gearshaft bearing will remain on ywheel pinion shaft. Remove retaining ring, and bearing may be slipped off pinion shaft. 12. See Figure 3-76. Place ywheel assembly in FLYWHEEL FIXTURE (Part No. HD-44385). Pull sprocket shaft bearing with SPROCKET SHAFT INNER TIMKIN BEARING REMOVER (Part No. HD-44404) and ALL PURPOSE CLAW PULLER (Part No. HD-95635-46) using bolts in place of jaws. Insert a penny (or suitable coin) between shaft and claw puller to avoid damaging shaft. 13. See Figure 3-77. Use CRANKSHAFT BEARING TOOL (Part No. HD-94547-101) to remove sprocket shaft outer races.
3528a
**Gearshaft Bearing Bearing Cup Right Crankcase Half Bearing Race Retaining Ring
Bearing *Shim Outer Bearing Spacer Snap Ring Bearing Oil Seal Cup
b0804a3x
a.
Pace the crankcase half on a at surface with the outboard side facing up. Obtain the two TIMKEN SNAP RING REMOVER/ INSTALLER (HD-44069). See Figure 3-78. With the gap in the retaining ring being the 12 oclock position, place the two claws so that the slotted sides engage the inside edge of the retaining ring at the 10 and 2 oclock positions. Using a 9/64 inch allen head bit, tighten the screws to x the position of the claws on the retaining ring. See Figure 3-79. Inserting the tips of a large retaining ring pliers (Snap-On PR-56A) into one hole in each claw, compress the retaining ring and remove it from the crankcase bore. Loosen allen head screws and remove claws from retaining ring.
b. c.
d.
3
e.
f.
b0805x3x
1. 2. 3. 4.
All Purpose Claw Puller (Part No. HD-95637-46) Sprocket Shaft Inner Timken Bearing Remover (Part No. HD-44404) Penny (or suitable coin) Flywheel Fixture (Part No. HD-44385) (Not Shown)
2809
3-53
HOME
8202
Connecting rods are bent or twisted. Connecting rods do not fall under their own weight or are in a bind. The crankshaft (roller) bearing inner race is burnelled, burnt, scored, blued or damaged. Figure 3-80. Checking Connecting Rod Side Play
2.
Inspect connecting rods for correct free play. a. Holding the shank of each rod just above the bearing bore, pull up and down on the connecting rods. Any discernible up and down movement indicates excessive lower bearing clearance. Replace the ywheel/connecting rod assembly.
b0870x3x
Piston Pin Bushing Flywheel Assembly *Paint Dot Inner Ring Retaining Ring
3.
See Figure 3-80. Check connecting rod side play. a. a. Insert a feeler gauge between the thrust washer and the outboard side of the connecting rod. Replace the assembly if the rod side play exceeds 0.030 inch (0.762 mm).
CLASS A B
* Paint dot on end of spline SERVICE WEAR LIMIT: 1.2492 in. (31.7297 mm) Figure 3-81. Low Inertia Flywheel and Connecting Rod Assembly/Factory Inner Race Sizes
HOME See Figure 3-81. Installed inner races are identied at the factory as shown. See Figure 3-82. Outer races are identied at the factory as shown. See Figure 3-83. To remove pinion shaft inner race, use TWO CLAW PULLER (Part No. HD-97292-61), CENTER CAP (Part HD-95652-43A), and BEARING SEPARATOR (SNAPON TOOLS Stock No. CJ950). Apply heat to race to aid removal. Four sizes of pinion bearings are available. Pinion bearing selection at the factory, during engine rebuild, or replacement of crankcase set or ywheel assembly is based on the largest measured outside diameter (OD) of the inner race and the smallest measured inside diameter (ID) of the outer race (crankcase bushing). A running clearance of 0.0002-0.0008 in. (0.0051-0.0203 mm) is established during crankcase set or ywheel assembly replacement and engine rebuild. See Figure 3-81. Installed inner races are identied at the factory as shown. See Figure 3-82. Outer races are identied at the factory as shown. NOTE The different sizes of crankcase sets and ywheel assemblies will not have separate part numbers. That is, a replacement crankcase set may have a class 1, 2 or 3 pinion outer race. Replacement ywheel assemblies will have either a class A or B inner race. See Figure 3-85. Pinion bearings are identied as shown. 1. 2. 3. Puller (Part No. HD-97292-61) Center Cap (Part No. HD-95652-43A) Bearing Separator (Snap-On Part No. CJ950)
3106a
b0176x3x
Outer Race
b0065x3x
RACE ID 1.5646-1.5648 in. (39.7408-39.7459 mm) 1.5648-1.5650 in. (39.7459-39.7510 mm) 1.5650-1.5652 in. (39.7510-39.7561 mm)
* Stamped number inside crankcase near race SERVICE WEAR LIMIT: 1.5672 in. (39.8069 mm) Figure 3-82. Factory Outer Race Sizes Figure 3-84. Bearing Identication
3-55
HOME
BEARING SELECTION
Select bearings using the identication information given for inner and outer races and bearings. See Table 3-11. and Table 3-12. NOTE If either inner or outer race show wear, measure both races to conrm correct bearing t. 1. Use a dial bore gauge to measure and record ID of outer race. Take four measurements on ID where bearing rollers ride. a. If the largest measurement is larger than 1.5672 in. (39.8069 mm) or the required lapping to remove wear marks would enlarge bore beyond 1.5672 in., continue at Step 5. If largest measurement is 1.5672 in. (39.8069 mm) or less, cover the cam bearings with masking tape to prevent debris from entering bearings. Assemble crankcase halves. 1.145 in. (29.083 mm)1.135 in. (28.829 mm)
1. 2.
2 1
Figure 3-85. Inner Race Location inner race must meet these specications. For necessary dimensions for constructing a press-on tool see Figure 3-131. When the tool bottoms against the ywheel, correct inner race location is automatically established. Roundness: within 0.0002 in. (0.0051 mm) Taper: within 0.0002 in. (0.0051 mm) Surface nish: 16 RMS NOTE Always use the smallest outer race ID measurement and the largest OD inner race measurement when selecting bearings. 9. The following example illustrates how to determine the required inner race OD. a. See Table 3-12. For example purposes, suppose the smallest outer race ID measurement is 1.5651 in. (39.754 mm). This requires an inner race OD range of 1.2496-1.2504 in. (31.740 - 31.760 mm).
b0165x3x
b.
NOTE The next step requires lapping the outer race. To keep sprocket shaft and pinion shaft bearings aligned the lap must be supported by an adaptor or pilot in the left crankcase half. 2. 3. 4. See LAPPING ENGINE MAIN BEARING RACES. Lap race until all wear marks are removed. Measure and record ID of race at four places. Check measurements against these specications: Largest ID measured: 1.5672 in. (39.8069 mm) or less Roundness of ID: within 0.0002 in. (0.0051 mm) Taper: within 0.0002 in. (0.0051) a. b. c. 5. If lapping increased bore ID to larger than 1.5672 in. (39.8069 mm), go to Step 5. If roundness or taper do not meet specications, continue lapping until specications are met. If all specications are met, continue at Step 7 to remove and size inner race.
Press the outer race from the right crankcase. Press new outer race into crankcase ush with inside edge of cast-in insert. See Figure 3-131. Dimensions are shown for fabrication of tools used in pressing the outer race into or out of crankcase.
NOTE Have machinist grind outer race to center or middle of required OD range. This will prevent grinding outer race undersize and gives a more easily achieved tolerance range. b. c. Grind inner race. Measure OD at four places. Check that specications in Step 8 are met. For example purposes, suppose the largest inner race OD measurement after grinding is 1.2499 in. (31.747 mm) OD. With a 1.5651 in. (39.754 mm) ID outer race and a 1.2499 in. (31.747 mm) OD inner race, a blue bearing is required.
6.
The new outer race must be lapped slightly to true and align with left case bearing and to meet the following specications. See LAPPING ENGINE MAIN BEARING RACES. ID: 1.5646 - 1.5652 in. (39.7408 - 39.7561 mm) Roundness: within 0.0002 in. (0.0051 mm) Taper: within 0.0002 in. (0.0051 mm) Surface nish: 16 RMS
d.
7.
See Figure 3-83. Pull inner race from pinion shaft using TWO CLAW PULLER (Part No. HD-97292-61), CENTER CAP (Part No. HD-95652-43A), and BEARING SEPARATOR (SNAP-ON TOOLS Stock No. CJ950). Apply heat to race to aid removal. See Figure 3-85. Press new inner race on pinion shaft as shown. The new inner race must be ground by a competent machinist to OD dimension range for the nished lapped ID of the outer race. See Table 3-12. The nished 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Engine
8.
3-56
HOME
2.
3.
5/16" (7.94 mm) DRILL 1.560" (39.62 mm) 1.50" (38.1 mm) 1.00" (25.4 mm)
4.
At frequent intervals, remove lap from crankcase, wash and inspect bushing. Lapping is completed when entire bushing surface has a dull, satin nish rather than a glossy, smooth appearance. If necessary, ush off lap in cleaning solvent, air dry and apply fresh, light coat of ne lapping compound.
1.145" (29.08 mm) 1.135" (28.83 mm)
3546a
3-57
HOME
over 1.5672 in. 39.807 mm 1.5670-1.5672 in. 39.802-39.807 mm 1.5668-1.5670 in. 39.797-39.802 mm 1.5666-1.5668 in. 39.792-39.797 mm 1.5664-1.5666 in. 39.787-39.792 mm 1.5662-1.5664 in. 39.781-39-787 mm 1.5660-1.5662 in. 39.776-39.781 mm 1.5658-1.5660 in. 39.771-39.776 mm 1.5656-1.5658 in. 39.766-39.771 mm 1.5654-1.5656 in. 39.761-39.766 mm 1.5652-1.5654 in. 39.756-39.761 mm 3 1.5650-1.5652 in. 39.751-39.756 mm 1.5648-1.5650 in. 39.746-39.751 mm 1.5646-1.5648 in. 39.741-39.746 mm INNER RACE OD (In) Red Red Red
Red
Red
Blue
Red
Blue
White-Gray
Red
Blue
White-Gray
Green
Red
Blue
White-Gray
Green
Red
Blue
White-Gray
Green
Red
Blue
White-Gray
Green
Red
Blue
White-Gray
Green
Blue
White-Gray
Green
Blue
White-Gray
Green
White-Gray
Green
Green
1.25001.2502 in.
1.25021.2504 in.
1.25041.2506 in.
1.25061.2508 in.
1.25081.2510 in.
1.25101.2512 in.
1.25121.2514 in.
1.25141.2516 in.
1.25161.2518 in.
31.740 31.745 31.75031.75531.76031.76531.77031.77531.78031.7863.79131.745 mm 31.750 mm 31.755 mm 31.760 mm 31.765 mm 31.770 mm 31.755 mm 31.780 mm 31.786 mm 31.791 mm 31.796 mm FACTORY COLOR CODE Green White
ASSEMBLY
Crankcase Halves
Lubricate all parts with Harley-Davidson 20W50 engine oil, and proceed as follows: 1. Install new snap ring to crankcase bore (if bearings were replaced). a. b. c. Pace the crankcase half on a at surface with the outboard side facing up. Obtain the two TIMKEN SNAP RING REMOVER/ INSTALLER (HD-44069). See Figure 3-78. With the gap in the snap ring being the 12 oclock position, place the two claws so that the slotted sides engage the inside edge of the snap ring at the 10 and 2 oclock positions. Using a 9/64 inch allen head bit, tighten the screws to x the position of the claws on the snap ring. See Figure 3-79. Inserting the tips of a large retaining ring pliers (Snap-On PR-56A) into one hole in each claw, compress the snap ring and install in groove of crankcase bore. 2001 Buell S3/S3T: Engine
f.
See Figure 3-133. Verify that the gap in the snap ring is centered below the oil hole at the top of the ring groove. Move snap ring if not properly centered. Loosen allen head screws and remove claws from snap ring.
g.
NOTE See Figure 3-134. Use SPROCKET SHAFT BEARING OUTER RACE INSTALLATION TOOL (1, 2) (Part No. HD39458) to install left and right outer races (4, 5) of sprocket shaft tapered roller bearings into left crankcase half (6). Always install left outer race (4) prior to installing right outer race (5) because the installer base (1) is usable only when you follow this sequence of race installation. 2. Insert SPORTSTER end of installer base (1) into inboard side of left crankcase half (6) bearing bore until base contacts installed retaining ring (3). Position left outer race (4) over bearing bore on outboard side of left crankcase half (6). Insert shaft of installer plug (2) through left outer race (4) and into installer base (1). Press race into bore until rmly seated against retaining ring (3). Insert SPORTSTER end of installer base (1) into outboard side of left crankcase half (6) bearing bore until
3. 4.
d. e.
5.
3-58
HOME base contacts outboard surface of installed left outer race (4). 6. 7. Position right outer race (5) over bearing bore on inboard side of left crankcase half (6). Insert shaft of installer plug (2) through right outer race (5) and into installer base (1). Press race into bore until rmly seated against retaining ring (3). 8. Install inner bearing (6). a. Place new bearing, small end upward, over end of sprocket shaft. Thread pilot (1) onto sprocket shaft until pilot bottoms on sprocket shaft shoulder. Sparingly apply graphite lubricant to threads of pilot shaft to ensure smooth operation. Slide sleeve (5) over pilot (1) until sleeve contacts inner bearing race. Install Nice bearing (4), washer (3) and handle (2) on top of sleeve. Rotate handle clockwise until bearing (6) contacts ywheel shoulder. Remove tool from sprocket shaft.
b.
NOTE See Figure 3-135. Use SPROCKET SHAFT BEARING/SEAL INSTALLATION TOOL (Part No. HD-42579) to install sprocket shaft tapered roller bearings and seal.
c.
d.
6151
e.
2
9. See Figure 3-75. Install shim and outer bearing. a. See Figure 3-136. Carefully place crankcase half over sprocket shaft so that it rests at on inner bearing. Slide new inner spacer over sprocket shaft until it contacts inner bearing race. Place new outer bearing, small end downward, over sprocket shaft. Assemble SPROCKET SHAFT BEARING/SEAL INSTALLATION TOOL (Part No. HD-42579) onto sprocket shaft. Follow procedure in Step 8. Rotate handle clockwise until bearing rmly contacts inner spacer. Inner and outer bearings must be tight against inner spacer for correct bearing clearance. Remove tool from sprocket shaft. Spin crankcase half to verify that ywheel assembly is free.
b.
c. 1. 2. 3. Snap Ring Oil Supply Hole Oil Supply Channel Figure 3-133. Snap Ring
d.
e.
b0168a3x
f.
2 6
10. See Figure 3-137. Install new spacer in seal ID. With the open (lipped) side facing outward, center seal/spacer assembly over bearing bore.
4
CAUTION Do not remove the spacer after installation or the new seal will have to be discarded and the procedure repeated. 11. See Figure 3-138. Install bearing seal and spacer. a. Center seal/spacer driver (2) over seal, so that the sleeve (smaller OD) seats between seal wall and garter spring. Assemble SPROCKET SHAFT BEARING/SEAL INSTALLATION TOOL (1) (Part No. HD-42579) and SPROCKET SHAFT SEAL/SPACER INSTALLER (Part No. HD-42774) onto sprocket shaft. Follow procedure in Step 8. Rotate handle clockwise until the spacer makes contact with the bearing. Remove tool from sprocket shaft.
3
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Installer Base Installer Plug Snap Ring Left Outer Race Right Outer Race Left Crankcase Half
b.
c.
3-59
HOME
6149
1 2 3 5 4 6
6162
Spacer
Seal
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
Pilot Handle Washer Nice Bearing Sleeve Inner Bearing Figure 3-135. Inner Bearing Installation (Typical)
6161
3-60
a. b. c.
Lubricate pinion shaft bearing with engine oil. Slip bearing on pinion shaft. Install new retaining ring in groove of pinion shaft bearing inner race.
13. Assemble crankcase halves together. a. b. c. d. e. Apply a thin coat of DOW CORNING SILASTIC or 3M 800 sealant to crankcase joint faces. Slide pinion shaft through outer race in right crankcase. Attach crankcase halves using hardware shown in Figure 3-73. Tighten the 1/4-in. fasteners to 70-110 in-lbs (8-12 Nm) Tighten the 5/16-in. fasteners to 15-19 ft-lbs (20-26 Nm).
1 2
1. 2.
Bearing/Seal Installer (Part No. HD-42579) Seal/Spacer Installer (Part No. HD-42774) Figure 3-138. Install Bearing Seal/Spacer
14. See Figure 3-140. Install cylinder studs. a. b. c. Pack clean towels into crankcase opening. Place a steel ball into a head screw (1). The cylinder studs (2) have a shoulder (3) at the lower end. Place the end of the stud without the shoulder into the head screw. Install the stud in the crankcase with the shoulder end down. Use an air gun (4) to drive the stud until the shoulder reaches the crankcase. Remove air gun. Use a torque wrench to tighten stud to 10-20 ft-lbs (14-27 Nm).
b0346x3x
d.
e.
15. Install pistons and cylinders. See 3.6 CYLINDER AND PISTON. 16. Install oil pump. See 3.13 OIL PUMP. 17. Install cam gears, gearcase cover, lifter guides and lifters. See 3.16 GEARCASE COVER AND CAM GEARS. 18. Install cylinder heads. See 3.5 CYLINDER HEAD. 19. Install starter. See 5.7 STARTER. 20. Install transmission. See 6.13 TRANSMISSION INSTALLATION AND SHIFTER PAWL ADJUSTMENT. 21. Install all primary drive components. This includes engine sprocket, primary chain, complete clutch assembly, engine sprocket nut and mainshaft nut. See 6.5 PRIMARY DRIVE/CLUTCH. 22. Install primary cover. See Primary Cover under 6.2 PRIMARY CHAIN. NOTE Be sure to rell transmission to proper level with fresh lubricant. See 1.8 CLUTCH. 23. See 3.4 INSTALLING THE ENGINE and perform the applicable steps.
1. 2. 3. 4.
Head Screw with Ball Inside Cylinder Stud Shoulder on Cylinder Stud Air Gun Figure 3-140. Cylinder Studs
3-61
HOME
NOTES
3-62
HOME
Table Of Contents
SUBJECT
PAGE NO. 4-96 4-97 4-98 4-99 4-100 4-103 4-105 4-106 4-109 4-113 4-115
4.32 Engine Temperature Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.33 Bank Angle Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.34 Intake Air Temperature Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.35 Throttle Position Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.36 Fuel Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.37 Fuel Tank Vent Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.38 Inline Fuel Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.39 Fuel Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.40 Throttle Body and Intake Manifold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.41 Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.42 Evaporative Emissions Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
HOME
SPECIFICATIONS
4.1
FUEL TANK CAPACITY Total (including Reserve) Reserve Low Fuel Indicator Light at
TORQUE VALUES
ITEM Backplate Mount Bolts Canister Mounting Clamp Screws Cylinder Head Breather Bolts Fuel Cap Flange Screws Fuel Pump Stud Nuts Fuel Supply Valve Screws Fuel Tank Mounting Bolt
TORQUE 3-5 ft-lbs 6-8 ft-lbs 10-15 ft-lbs 22-25 in-lbs 68-75 in-lbs 25-27 in-lbs 18-23 ft-lbs, then wait 5 min. and retighten to 18-23 ft-lbs. 25-30 ft-lbs 6-10 ft-lbs 6-8 ft-lbs 30-33 ft-lbs 4-7 Nm 8-11 Nm 14-20 Nm 2.5-2.8 Nm 8-9 Nm 2.8-3.1 Nm HYLOMAR
24-31 Nm
special procedure
Ignition Bracket Screw Intake Manifold Screws Snorkel Plate Screws Tie Bar Bolts
4-1
HOME
NOTES
4-2